Nothing Special   »   [go: up one dir, main page]

EP1053246B1 - Beta-sheet mimetics and methods relating to the use thereof - Google Patents

Beta-sheet mimetics and methods relating to the use thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
EP1053246B1
EP1053246B1 EP98908551A EP98908551A EP1053246B1 EP 1053246 B1 EP1053246 B1 EP 1053246B1 EP 98908551 A EP98908551 A EP 98908551A EP 98908551 A EP98908551 A EP 98908551A EP 1053246 B1 EP1053246 B1 EP 1053246B1
Authority
EP
European Patent Office
Prior art keywords
mmol
solution
synthesis
added
stirred
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Expired - Lifetime
Application number
EP98908551A
Other languages
German (de)
French (fr)
Other versions
EP1053246A1 (en
Inventor
Maher N. Qaber
Michael K. Mcmillian
Michael S. Kahn
John E. Tulinsky
Jessymol Mathew
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Molecumetics Ltd
Original Assignee
Molecumetics Ltd
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Molecumetics Ltd filed Critical Molecumetics Ltd
Publication of EP1053246A1 publication Critical patent/EP1053246A1/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of EP1053246B1 publication Critical patent/EP1053246B1/en
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Expired - Lifetime legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K5/00Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K5/04Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K5/06Dipeptides
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D209/00Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings, condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D209/02Heterocyclic compounds containing five-membered rings, condensed with other rings, with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom condensed with one carbocyclic ring
    • C07D209/44Iso-indoles; Hydrogenated iso-indoles
    • C07D209/48Iso-indoles; Hydrogenated iso-indoles with oxygen atoms in positions 1 and 3, e.g. phthalimide
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D487/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00
    • C07D487/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D487/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K5/00Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K5/04Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K5/06Dipeptides
    • C07K5/06139Dipeptides with the first amino acid being heterocyclic
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K7/00Peptides having 5 to 20 amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K7/04Linear peptides containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K7/06Linear peptides containing only normal peptide links having 5 to 11 amino acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides

Definitions

  • This invention relates generally to ( ⁇ -sheet mimetics and, more specifically, to ( ⁇ -sheet mimetics which inhibit biologically active peptides and proteins.
  • the ⁇ -sheet conformation (also referred to as a ⁇ -strand conformation) is a secondary structure present in many polypeptides.
  • the ⁇ -sheet conformation is nearly fully extended, with axial distances between adjacent amino acids of approximately 3.5 ⁇ .
  • the ⁇ -sheet is stabilized by hydrogen bonds between NH and CO groups in different polypeptides strands. Additionally, the dipoles of the peptide bonds alternate along the strands which imparts intrinsic stability to the ⁇ -sheet.
  • the adjacent strands in the ⁇ -sheet can run in the same direction ( i.e. , a parallel ⁇ -sheet) or in opposite directions ( i.e. , an antiparallel ⁇ -sheet). Although the two forms differ slightly in dihedral angles, both are sterically favorable.
  • the extended conformation of the ⁇ -sheet conformation results in the amino acid side chains protruding on alternating faces of the ⁇ -sheet.
  • the ⁇ -sheet is important in a number of biological protein-protein recognition events, including interactions between proteases and their substrates, protein kinases and their substrates or inhibitors, the binding of SH2 domain containing proteins to their cognate phosphotyrosine containing protein targets, farnesyl transferase- to its protein substrates, and MHC I and II and their antigenic peptides, and has been implicated in many disease states.
  • Ras the protein product of the ras oncogene
  • ras oncogene is a membrane bound protein involved in signal transduction regulating cell division and growth. Mutations in the ras gene are among the most common genetic abnormalities associated with human cancers (Barbacid, M. "ras genes,” 56 :779-827, 1987). These mutations result in a growth signal which is always "on,” leading to a cancerous cell.
  • Ras requires prenylation of the cysteine within its C-terminal CaaX sequence by farnesyl transferase (FTase).
  • FTase farnesyl transferase
  • SH2 domains originally identified in the src subfamily of PTKs, are noncatalytic sequences and consist of about 100 amino acids conserved among a variety of signal transducing proteins (Cohen et al., Cell 80 :237-248, 1995). SH2 domains function as phosphotyrosine-binding modules and mediate critical protein-protein associations (Pawson, Nature 573-580, 1995). In particular, the role of SH2 domains has been clearly defined as critical signal transducers for receptor tyrosine kinases (RTKs such as EGF-R, PDGF, insulin receptor, etc.).
  • RTKs receptor tyrosine kinases
  • Phosphotyrosine-containing sites on autophosphorylated RTKs serve as binding sites for SH2-proteins and thereby mediate the activation of biochemical signaling pathways (Carpenter, G., FAESEB J. 6 :3283-3289, 1992; Sierke, S. and Koland, J., Biochem. 32 :10102-10108, 1993).
  • the SH2 domains are responsible for coupling the activated growth-factor receptors to cellular responses which include alterations in gene expression, cell proliferation, cytoskeletal architecture and metabolism.
  • cytosolic proteins that contain SH2 domains and function in intracellular signaling.
  • the distribution of SH2 domains is not restricted to a particular protein family, but is found in several classes of proteins, protein kinases, lipid kinases, protein phosphatases, phospholipases, Ras-controlling proteins and some transcription factors.
  • Many of the SH2-containing proteins have known enzymatic activities while others (Grb2 and Crk) function as "linkers” and "adapters” between cell surface receptors and downstream effector molecules (Marengere, L., et al., Nature 369 :502-505, 1994).
  • proteins containing SH2 domains with enzymatic activities that are activated in signal transduction include, but are not limited to, the src subfamily of protein tyrosine kinases (src (pp60 c-src ), abl, lck, fyn, fgr and others), phospholipase-C- ⁇ (PLC- ⁇ ), phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase (Pl-3-kinase), p21-ras GTPase activating protein (GAP) and SH2 containing protein tyrosine phosphatases (SH-PTPase) (Songyang et al., Cell 72 :767-778, 1993).
  • src pp60 c-src
  • abl abl
  • lck abl
  • lck abl
  • lck phospholipase-C- ⁇
  • PLC- ⁇ phospholipase-C- ⁇
  • Intracellular tyrosines are phosphorylated when surface receptors are engaged by diverse ligands for growth factor receptors, cytokine receptors, insulin receptor, and antigen-mediated signaling through T- or B-cell receptors.
  • the phosphorylation of proteins at tyrosine residues is critical in the cellular signal transduction, neoplastic transformation and control of the cell cycle. Due to the central role these various SH2-proteins occupy in transmitting signals from activated cell surface receptors into a cascade of additional molecular interactions that ultimately define cellular responses, inhibitors which block specific SH2-protein binding are desirable as agents for a variety of potential therapeutic applications.
  • SH2 domains which mediate signaling are clearly significant elements in the regulation of oncogene and protooncogene tyrosine kinase activity and cellular proliferation (Carpenter, Fed. Am. Soc. Exp. Biol. J. 6 :3283-3289, 1992).
  • the SH2 domains define an important set of substrates through which activated RTKs mediate signaling and through which nonreceptor tyrosine kinases associate with RTKs and are thus targets for anticancer drug development.
  • the ability to block interaction of the RTK with the SH2-containing substrate using a mimetic inhibitor provides a means to abrogate signaling and thereby eliminate oncogenic activity.
  • v-crk oncogene a protein composed almost entirely of SH domains, which is able to bring about cellular transformation by interacting with phosphotyrosine containing proteins.
  • the ability of inhibitors to block v-crk binding via its SH2 domain to other proteins would be expected to be effective as an anticancer agent.
  • T-cell activation via the antigen specific T-cell receptor (TCR) initiates a signal transduction cascade leading to lymphokine secretion and cell proliferation.
  • TCR antigen specific T-cell receptor
  • One of the earliest biochemical responses following TCR activation is an increase in tyrosine kinase activity.
  • T-cell activation and proliferation is controlled through T-cell receptor mediated activation of p56 lck and p59 fyn tyrosine kinases, as well as ZAP-70 and Syk (Weiss and Litman, Cell 76:263-274, 1994) which contain SH2 domains.
  • src-family kinases (lck blk, fyn) participate in signal transduction pathways leading from B-cell antigen receptors and hence may serve to integrate stimuli received from several independent receptor structures.
  • inhibitors that block interactions of these SH2 domain kinases with their cognate receptors could serve as immunosuppressive agents with utility in autoimmune diseases, transplant rejection or as anti-inflammatory agents as well as anticancer drugs in cases of lymphocytic leukemias.
  • SH-PTP1 and SH-PTP2 are known and nomenclature refers to them as SH-PTP1 and SH-PTP2 (Neel, Cell Biology 4 :419-432, 1993) SH-PTP1 is identical to PTP1C, HCP or SHP and SH-PTP2 is also known as PTP1D or PTP2C.
  • SH-PTP1 is expressed at high levels in hematopoietic cells of all lineages and all stages of differentiation. Since the SH-PTP1 gene was identified as responsible for the motheaten ( me ) mouse phenotype, this provides a basis for predicting the effects of inhibitors that would block its interaction with its cellular substates. Thus, inhibition of SH-PTP1 function would be expected to result in impaired T-cell responses to mitogenic stimulation, decreased NK cell function, and depletion of B-cell precursors with potential therapeutic applications as described above.
  • tyrosine phosphatases In Type 2 (non-insulin dependent) diabetes, tyrosine phosphatases (SH-PTP2) counter-balance the effect of activated insulin-receptor kinases and may represent important drug targets.
  • SH-PTP2 tyrosine phosphatases
  • In vitro experiments show that injection of PTPase blocks insulin stimulated-phosphorylation of tyrosyl residues on endogenous proteins. Thus, inhibitors could serve to modulate insulin action in diabetes.
  • Glial growth factors are ligands that are specific activators of erb-B2 receptor tyrosine kinase (p185 erbB2 ) to promote tyrosine phosphorylation and mitogenic responses of Schwann cells. Consequently, regulation of tyrosine phosphorylation by altering activity in Schwann cells following nerve injury could be an important therapeutic strategy. Inhibitors of erb-B2 signaling activity could have a significant role in treatment of tumors of glial cell origin.
  • Another class of ⁇ -sheet mimetics are inhibitors of protein kinases, which include the protein tyrosine kinases and serine/threonine kinases.
  • RTK subfamilies are recognizable on the basis of architectural similarities in the catalytic domain as well as distinctive motifs in the extracellular ligand binding regions. Based upon these structural considerations, a nomenclature defining several subfamilies of RTKs, each containing several members, has been developed (Hanks, Curr. Opin. Struc. Biol. 1 :369-383, 1991; Ullrich, A., and Schlessinger, J . Cell 61 :203-212, 1990).
  • receptor subfamilies referred to on the basis of their prototypic members include: EGF-receptor, insulin receptor, platelet-derived growth factor (PDGF-receptor), fibroblast growth factor receptors (FGFRs), TRK receptor and EPH/ECK receptors.
  • EGF-receptor insulin receptor
  • PDGF-receptor platelet-derived growth factor
  • FGFRs fibroblast growth factor receptors
  • TRK receptor EPH/ECK receptors
  • HER3 expression is amplified in a variety of human adenocarcinomas.
  • Several inhibitors are known which demonstrate inhibitory activity in vitro against the EGFR and block EGF-dependent cell proliferation which indicates therapeutic potential of compounds with this activity.
  • enhanced tyrosine kinase activity underlies the disease as a consequence of activation of the cellular c-abl protooncogene. Inhibitors would function as anticancer agents.
  • Angiogenesis Currently, there are at least seven FGFR members which mediate a diverse array of biological responses, including the capacity to induce angiogenesis. In addition, a group of RTKs with seven lgLs has been proposed to represent a separate subfamily. Its known members, FLT1, FLK1 and FLT4 show a similarity of structure and expression. These receptors mediate the actions of Vascular Endothelial Growth Factor (VEGF).
  • VEGF Vascular Endothelial Growth Factor
  • the PDGF receptor is of great interest as a target for inhibition in the cardiovascular field since it is believed to play a significant role in restenosis after coronary balloon angioplasties and also in atherosclerosis.
  • the release of PDGF by platelets at damaged surfaces of blood vessels results in stimulation of PDGF receptors on vascular smooth muscle cells, and eventual neointimal thickening.
  • a mimetic inhibitor of kinase activity would prevent proliferation and lead to greater successful outcomes from this surgical procedure.
  • PKC plays a crucial role in cell-surface signal transduction for controlling a variety of physiological processes (Nishizuka, Nature 334 :661-665, 1988) and represents a large family of isoenzymes which differ in their structure and expression in different tissues, as well as their substrate specificity (Hug and Sarre, Biochem J. 291 :329-343, 1993). Molecular cloning has demonstrated at least 8 isoenzymes. Due to this diversity and differential expression, activation of individual isoenzymes produces differing cell-specific responses: stimulation of growth, inhibition of differentiation, or induction of differentiation. Due to its ability to stimulate cellular proliferation, it represents a target for anticancer drug development (Powis, Trends in Pharm. Sci. 12 :188-194, 1991).
  • PKC isoenzymes in mammalian cells is correlated with enhanced expression of early protooncogenes such as c-jun, c-fos, c-myc and one overexpressing cell line gives rise to tumors in nude mice.
  • T-cells by antigens involves activation of PKC.
  • Activated PKC subsequently activates a branch of the signal cascade that is necessary for transcriptional activation of NF- ⁇ B, production of IL-2, and ultimately, T-cell proliferation.
  • Inhibitors that block signaling through this branch pathway have been shown to prevent T-cell activation.
  • mimetics that would function as inhibitors of PKC in T-cells would block signaling and serve as possible immunosuppressants useful in transplant rejection or as anticancer agents for lymphocytic leukemias.
  • Activators of PKC cause edema and inflammation in mouse skin (Hennings et al., Carcinogenesis 8 :1342-1346, 1987) and thus inhibitors are also expected to serve as potent anti-inflammatory compounds. Such anti-inflammatory activates would find use in asthma, arthritis and other inflammatory mediated processes.
  • staurosporine and its analogs, UCN01 and CGP4125 which have been characterized as potent PKC inhibitors in vitro, have anti-tumor activity in animal models (Powis, Trends in Pharm. Sci. 12 :188-194, 1991), and related compounds are being considered for clinical trials.
  • Cathepsin B is a lysosomal cysteine protease normally involved in proenzyme processing and protein turnover. Elevated levels of activity have been implicated in tumor metastasis (Sloane, B.F. et al., "Cathepsin B and its endogenous inhibitors: the role in tumor malignancy," Cancer Metastasis Rev. 9 :333-352, 1990), rheumatoid arthritis (Werb, Z. "Proteinases and matrix degradation," in Textbook of Rheumatology, Keller, W.N.; Harris, W.D.; Ruddy, S.; Sledge, C.S., Eds., 1989, W.B.
  • Calpains are cytosolic or membrane bound Ca++-activated proteases which are responsible for degradation of cytoskeletal proteins in response to changing calcium levels within the cell. They contribute to tissue degradation in arthritis and muscular dystrophy (see Wang K.K. & Yuen P.W., "Calpain inhibition: an overview of its therapeutic potential,” Trends Pharmacol. Sci. 15 :412-419, 1994).
  • Interleukin Converting Enzyme cleaves pro-IL-1 beta to IL-1 beta, a key mediator of inflammation, and therefore inhibitors of ICE may prove useful in the treatment of arthritis (see, e.g., Miller B.E. et al., "Inhibition of mature IL-1 beta production in murine macrophages and a murine model of inflammation by WIN 67694, an inhibitor of IL-1 beta converting enzyme," J. Immunol . 154 :1331-1338, 1995).
  • ICE Interleukin Converting Enzyme
  • ICE or ICE-like proteases may also function in apoptosis (programmed cell death) and therefore play roles in cancer, AIDS, Alzheimer's disease, and other diseases in which disregulated apoptosis is involved ( see Barr, P.J.; Tomei, L.D., "Apoptosis and its Role in Human Disease,” Biotechnol. 12 :487-493, 1994).
  • HIV protease plays a key role in the life cycle of HIV, the AIDS virus. In the final steps of viral maturation it cleaves polyprotein precursors to the functional enzymes and structural proteins of the virion core. HIV protease inhibitors were quickly identified as an excellent therapeutic target for AIDS (see Huff, J.R., "HIV protease: a novel chemotherapeutic target for AIDS," J . Med . Chem . 34 :2305-2314) and have already proven useful in its treatment as evidenced by the recent FDA approval of ritonavir, Crixivan, and saquinavir.
  • Angiotensin converting enzyme is part of the renin-angiotensin system which plays a central role in the regulation of blood pressure.
  • ACE cleaves angiotensin I to the octapeptide angiotensin II, a potent pressor agent due to its vasoconstrictor activity.
  • Inhibition of ACE has proved therapeutically useful in the treatment of hypertension (Williams, G.H., "Converting-enzyme inhibitors in the treatment of hypertension," N. Engl. J. Med. 319 :1517-1525, 1989.
  • HCV Hepatitis C virus
  • Collagenases cleave collagen, the major constituent of the extracellular matrix (e.g. , connective tissue, skin, blood vessels). Elevated collagenase activity contributes to arthritis (Krane S.M. et al., "Mechanisms of matrix degradation in rheumatoid arthritis," Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci . 580 :340-354, 1990.), tumor metastasis (Plug M. & Kopf-Maier P., "The basement membrane and its involvement in carcinoma cell invasion,” Acta Anat. Basel 152 :69-84, 1995), and other diseases involving the degradation of connective tissue.
  • arthritis Kerman S.M. et al., "Mechanisms of matrix degradation in rheumatoid arthritis," Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci . 580 :340-354, 1990.
  • tumor metastasis Plug M. & Kopf-Maier P., "The basement membrane and its involvement in carcinoma cell invasion," Acta
  • Trypsin-like serine proteases form a large and highly selective family of enzymes involved in hemostasis/coagulation (Davie, E.W. and K. Fujikawa, "Basic mechanisms in blood coagulation,” Ann. Rev. 799-829, 1975) and complement activation (Muller-Eberhard, H.J., "Complement,” Ann. Rev. Biochem. 44 :697-724, 1975).
  • Thrombin a trypsin-like serine protease, acts to provide limited proteolysis, both in the generation of fibrin from fibrinogen and the activation of the platelet receptor, and thus plays a critical role in thrombosis and hemostasis (Mann, K.G., "The assembly of blood clotting complexes on membranes,” Trends Biochem. Sci. 12 :229-233, 1987).
  • Thrombin exhibits remarkable specificity in the removal of fibrinopeptides A and B of fibrinogen through the selective cleavage of only two Arg-Gly bonds of the one-hundred and eighty-one Arg- or Lys-Xaa sequences in fibrinogen (Blomback, H., Blood Clotting Enzymology, Seeger, W.H. (ed.), Academic Press, New York, 1967, pp. 143-215).
  • Aspirin and heparin are widely used in the treatment of patients with acute coronary syndromes.
  • these agents have several intrinsic limitations.
  • thrombosis complicating the rupture of atherosclerotic plaque tends to be a thrombin-mediated, platelet-dependent process that is relatively resistant to inhibition by aspirin and heparin (Fuster et al., "The pathogenesis of coronary artery disease and the acute coronary syndromes," N. Engl. J. Med. 326 :242-50, 1992).
  • Thrombin inhibitors prevent thrombus formation at sites of vascular injury in vivo. Furthermore, since thrombin is also a potent growth factor which initiates smooth muscle cell proliferation at sites of mechanical injury in the coronary artery, inhibitors block this proliferative smooth muscle cell response and reduce restenosis. Thrombin inhibitors would also reduce the inflammatory response in vascular wall cells (Harker et al., Am. J . Cardiol. 75 :12B-16B, 1995).
  • NF- ⁇ B and AP-1 are regulated by the intracellular reduction-oxidation (redox) state.
  • redox reduction-oxidation
  • binding sites of the redox-regulated transcription factors NF- ⁇ B and AP-1 are located in the promoter region of a large variety of genes that are directly involved in the pathogenesis of diseases, such as AIDS, cancer, atherosclerosis and diabetic complications (Sen and Packer, FASEB Journal 10 :709-720, 1996). More specifically, the binding of transcription factors such NF- ⁇ B and AP-1 to consensus sites on DNA is driven by oxidant-antioxidant homeostasis, especially by the thiol-disulfide balance.
  • thioredoxin is an important protein oxidoreductase with antioxidant functions. Thioredoxin has been found to upregulate DNA binding of activated NF- ⁇ B and thus augments gene expression (Schenk et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91 :1672-1676, 1994). Thioredoxin has been implicated in reducing activated cytosolic NF- ⁇ B (specifically reduction of cys-62), which may thus contribute to its nuclear translocation and DNA binding (Hayashi et at., J. Biol. Chem. 268 :11380-11388, 1993).
  • DNA binding activity of Fos and Jun in the AP-1 complex has also been found to be regulated by the redox state (Abate et al., Science 249 :1157-1162, 1990).
  • Each protein contains a single conserved cysteine (flanked by lysine and arginine) in its DNA binding domain. This thiol does not appear to be part of a disulfide bond and may exist as a sulfenic or sulfinic acid in its oxidized form.
  • Ref-1 a bifunctional nuclear protein also possessing endonuclease DNA repair activity, stimulates AP-1 DNA binding by reduction of this regulatory cysteine.
  • NF- ⁇ B and AP-1 have important therapeutic implications.
  • AP-1 is an important mediator of tumor production (Yoshioka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 92 :4972-4976, 1995).
  • compounds that repress AP-1 transcriptional activity have utility in the treatment of cancer.
  • the activation of NF- ⁇ B plays an important role in the development of chronic diseases such as rheumatoid arthritis and acute conditions such as septic shock.
  • NF- ⁇ B Autoimmune diseases, such as systemic lupus erythromatus (SLE), and Alzheimer's disease are also believed involved in activation of NF- ⁇ B. Similarly, NF- ⁇ B plays an important role in the activation of HIV gene expression. Further conditions which are believed to involve NF- ⁇ B include the flu, atherosclerosis, oncogenesis and ataxia telangiectasia (AT).
  • SLE systemic lupus erythromatus
  • AT ataxia telangiectasia
  • Proteins containing PDZ domains constitute an additional potential target for b-sheet mimetics. These domains of 80-100 amino acid residues mediate protein-protein interactions by binding to a consensus X-Ser/Thr-X-Val sequence at the very carboxyl terminus of proteins. There are also examples of protein interactions via PDZ domains that are internal (or non C-terminal). The crystal structure of liganded and unliganded PDZ domains have been determined and show a six b-strand and two a-helix structure that binds the consensus recognition polypeptide sequence through a b-sheet conformation. Hence, screening of appropriate b-sheet mimetics should prove a valid strategy for targeting PDZ domain-containing proteins.
  • PSD-95 a membrane associated guanylate kinase contains three PDZ domains, two of which target the Shaker-type K + channel and the N-methyl-D-aspartate (NMDA) receptor resulting in their clustering that is required for their function.
  • NMDA N-methyl-D-aspartate
  • PTPL1/FAP1 a protein tyrosine phosphatase, has five PDZ domains, two of which interact with Fas, a transmembrane protein of the tumor necrosis factor receptor family, that mediates apoptosis in many cell types.
  • Fas a transmembrane protein of the tumor necrosis factor receptor family
  • Tryptase a trypsin-like serine protease found exclusively in mast cells, has attracted much interest due to its potential role as a mediator of inflammation.
  • tryptase is released along with other mediators of inflammation in response to binding of an inhaled antigen to cell-surface IgE receptors (Ishizaka and Ishizaka, Prog. Allergy 34:188-235, 1984).
  • Tryptase has also been shown to cleave vasoactive intestinal peptide in vitro (Caughey et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 244:133-137, 1988; Tam and Caughey, Am. J. Respir. Cell Mol. Biol .
  • tryptase may play a role in atheromatous rupture (release of the thrombus), the final event of coronary atherosclerosis (Kaartinen et al., Circulation 90:1669-1678, 1994).
  • Tryptase cleaves fibrinogen but is not inactivated in the presence of endogenous proteinase inhibitors (Schwartz et al., J. Immunol. 135:2762-2767, 1985; Ren et al., J. Immunol. 159:3540-3548, 1997), and may function as a local anticoagulant. It has been demonstrated to be a potent mitogen for fibroblasts and may be involved in pulmonary fibrosis and interstitial lung disease (Ruoss et al., J. Clin. Invest. 88 :493-499, 1991).
  • Tryptase may also be responsible for the activation of PAR-2 (proteinase activated receptor-2) on endothelial cells and keratinocytes (Molino et al., J. Biol. Chem. 272:4043-4049, 1997).
  • PAR-2 proteinase activated receptor-2
  • Inhibitors of tryptase may be useful for preventing or treating asthma, pulmonary fibrosis and interstitial pneumonia, nephritis, hepatic fibrosis, hepatitis, hepatic cirrhosis, scleroderma, psoriasis, atopic dermatitis, chronic rheumatoid arthritis, influenza, Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis, inflammatory bowel disease, nasal allergy, and atherosclerosis.
  • Chymase is a chymotrypsin-like protease that is also released from mast cells. It has been demonstrated to cleave angiotensin-I (ang-I) to angiotensin-II (ang-II) with greater efficiency and selectivity than angiotensin-I converting enzyme (ACE) (Okunishi et al., J. Hypertension 2: 227-284, 1984; Urata et al., Circ. Res. 66: 883-890, 1990). In heart tissue chymase has been shown to be a major source of ang-II production from ang-I (Dell'Italia et al., Am. J. Physiol. (Heart Circ. Physiol.).
  • Urokinase-type plasminogen activator is a trypsin-like serine proteinase which converts plasminogen to plasmin as part of the fibrinolytic system. It has long been used for thrombolysis in acute massive pulmonary embolism. Other research has shown that uPA is also a key initiator of the extra-cellular proteolytic cascade involved in cellular invasiveness (Mullins and Rohlich, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 695: 177-214, 1983; Testa and Quigly, Cancer Metast. Rev. 9:353-367, 1990).
  • uPA binds to uPA receptor (uPAR) through its growth factor domain and further modulates the activity of other proteins involved in cell migration.
  • uPA receptor uPA receptor
  • Overexpression of uPA appears to play a part in cancer invasiveness and metastasis; high levels of uPA, PAI-1 (plasminogen activator inhibitor-1), and uPAR correlate with poor patient prognosis.
  • PAI-1 plasmaogen activator inhibitor-1
  • uPAR uPA receptor
  • a variety of research in various model systems demonstrates that inhibitors of uPA decrease tumor cell invasiveness and metastasis (Testa and Quigly, ibid ; Andreasen et al., Int J Cancer 72:1-22, 1997).
  • inhibition of uPA may be useful in the treatment of breast cancer, prostate cancer, ovarian cancer, human renal cell cancer, gastric cancer, and lung cancer.
  • inhibitors of uPA may also be useful in the prevention of restenosis (Loskutoff, Circulation 96 :2772-2774, 1997).
  • the present invention is directed to ⁇ -sheet mimetics and the use thereof, including use for the manufacture of a medicament for achieving therapeutic effects in a warm-blooded animal through one or more of protease inhibition, kinase inhibition, regulation of a transcription factor and/or by inhibiting protein-protein binding interactions.
  • the therapeutic effects result from administering to the warm-blooded animal a therapeutically effective amount of a ⁇ -sheet mimetic having the general structure as set forth in claim 1.
  • Such a structure includes a bicyclic ring system, of general structure (I) (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof) : wherein
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following structure (II): wherein A, B, C, D, R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I).
  • the six-member ring may be saturated or unsaturated (including aromatic).
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following aromatic structures (IIc) and (IId):
  • the following unsaturated compounds having structures (IIe) and (IIf) are also representative of the bicyclic ring system of structures (IIa) and (IIb) :
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following structure (III): wherein A, B, C, D, R 1 , R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I).
  • the six-member ring may be saturated or unsaturated (including aromatic).
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following aromatic structures (IIIc) and (IIId):
  • the following unsaturated compounds having structures (IIIe) and (IIIf) are also representative of the bicyclic ring system of structures (IIIa) and (IIIb):
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following structure (IV): wherein A, B, C, D, R 1 , R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I), and with the proviso that Z does not contain an -NH- moiety attached to the carbon atom having the R 1 substituent (and thus distinct from the bicyclic ring system of structure (III) above).
  • the six-member ring may be saturated or unsaturated (including aromatic).
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following aromatic structures (IVc) and (IVd):
  • the following unsaturated compounds having structures (IVe) and (IVf) are also representative of the bicyclic ring system of structures (IVa) and (IVb):
  • the bicyclic ring system include the following structures (V), (VI) and (VII): wherein A, B, C, D, R 1 , R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I).
  • the compounds according to the invention have a structure including: the bicyclic ring system shown above.
  • R 2 taken together with C forms a substituted or unsubstituted, homocyclic or heterocyclic fused ring compounds of this inventions include those of the following structures (IX) and (X): wherein A, B, C, D, E, R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 and Y are as defined above, and R' is one or more optional ring substituents.
  • Figure 1 is a plot showing the effect of various concentrations of structure (20b) on platelet deposition in a vascular graft.
  • Figure 2 is a plot showing the effect of various concentrations of structure (39) on platelet deposition in a vascular graft.
  • Figure 3 is a plot showing the effect of various concentrations of structure (29b) on platelet deposition in a vascular graft.
  • FIGS 4A and 4B illustrate the bioavailability of structure (20b) via both IV and PO administration.
  • Figures 5A and 5B illustrate the ability of structures (221-5) and (221-6) to serve as antithrombotic agents.
  • the ( ⁇ -sheet is an important structural component for many biological recognition events.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention serve to impart and/or stabilize the ⁇ -sheet structure of a natural or synthetic peptide, protein or molecule, particularly with regard to conformational stability.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention are more resistant to proteolytic breakdown, thus rendering a peptide, protein or molecule containing the same more resistant to degradation.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetic may be positioned at either the C-terminus or N-terminus of the protein, peptide or molecule, or it may be located within the protein, peptide or molecule itself, and more than one ⁇ -sheet mimetic of the present invention may be incorporated in a protein, peptide or molecule.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention include the bicyclic ring system generally represented by structure (I) above as well as the more specific structures (II) through (VII) and are represented by structures (IX) through (XI).
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention may be constructed to mimic the three-dimensional conformation of a ⁇ -sheet comprised of naturally occurring L-amino acids, as well as the structure of a ⁇ -sheet comprised of one or more D-amino acids. Thus, all stereoconformations of the bicyclic ring system of structure (I) are included within the compounds of this invention.
  • the bicyclic ring system of structure (II) includes the following structures (II') and (II"):
  • the bicyclic ring system of structure (III) includes the following structures (III') through (III""):
  • the bicyclic ring system of structure (IV) includes these same stereoconfirmations, but with the "Z-NH” moiety of structures (III') through (III'''') replaced with a "Z" moiety.
  • an amino acid side chain moiety as used to define the R 1 , R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , and R 4 moieties represents any amino acid side chain moiety present in naturally occurring proteins, including (but not limited to) the naturally occurring amino acid side chain moieties identified in Table 1 below.
  • side chain moieties of this invention include (but are not limited to) the side chain moieties of phenylglycine, 3,5-dibromotyrosine, 3,5-diiodotyrosine, hydroxylysine, naphthylalanine, thienylalanine, ⁇ -carboxyglutamate, phosphotyrosine, phosphoserine and glycosylated amino acids such as glycosylated serine, asparagine and threonine.
  • amino acid side chain moieties of the present invention also include various derivatives thereof.
  • a "derivative" of an amino acid side chain moiety includes all modifications and/or variations to naturally occurring amino acid side chain moieties.
  • the amino acid side chain moieties of alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, phenylglycine and phenylalanine may generally be classified as lower chain alkyl, aryl or aralkyl moieties.
  • Derivatives of amino acid side chain moieties include other straight chain or branched, cyclic or noncyclic, substituted or unsubstituted, saturated or unsaturated lower chain alkyl, aryl or aralkyl moieties.
  • amino acid side chain derivative is selected from a C 1-12 alkyl, a C 6-12 aryl and a C 7-12 aralkyl, and in a more preferred embodiment, from a C 1-7 alkyl, a C 6-10 aryl and a C 7-11 aralkyl.
  • Amino acid side chain derivatives of this invention further include substituted derivatives of lower chain alkyl, aryl and aralkyl moieties, wherein the substituent is selected from (but are not limited to) one or more of the following chemical moieties: -OH, -OR, - COOH, -COOR, -CONH 2 , -NH 2 , -NHR, -NRR, -SH, -SR, -SO 2 R, -SO 2 H, -SOR and halogen (including F, Cl, Br and I), wherein each occurrence of R is independently selected from a lower chain alkyl, aryl or aralkyl moiety.
  • cyclic lower chain alkyl, aryl and aralkyl moieties of this invention include naphthalene, as well as heterocyclic compounds such as thiophene, pyrrole, furan, imidazole, oxazole, thiazole, pyrazole, 3-pyrroline, pyrrolidine, pyridine, pyrimidine, purine, quinoline, isoquinoline and carbazole.
  • Amino acid side chain derivatives further include heteroalkyl derivatives of the alkyl portion of the lower chain alkyl and aralkyl moieties, including (but not limited to) alkyl and aralkyl phosphonates and silanes.
  • the term "remainder of the molecule" may be any chemical moiety, including (but not limited to) amino acid side chain moieties and derivatives thereof as defined above.
  • Y and Z may represent amino acids of the peptide or protein.
  • the Y moiety of a first ⁇ -sheet mimetic may represent a second ⁇ -sheet mimetic while, conversely, the Z moiety of the second ⁇ -sheet mimetic represents the first ⁇ -sheet mimetic.
  • Y and/or Z may represent a suitable terminating moiety.
  • suitable Z and Y terminating moieties of this invention include the following groups: Z Moieties Y Moieties R 6 -X- -X-R 6 R 7 -X- -X-R 7 (R 8 ) 2 N-X- -X-N(R 8 ) 2 R 9 -O-X- -X-O-R 9 R 10 -S(O) p -X- -X-S(O) p R 10 wherein
  • the Y terminating moiety further includes the following group: -N( ⁇ C(R 11 ) 2 C(O) -T m ⁇ n -W k -R 12 ) 2 wherein
  • any two adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring may form a double bond.
  • double bonds may be present in isolation or conjugation with one or more additional double bonds, including aromatic ring systems.
  • representative isolated double bonds includes the bicyclic ring system of structures (IIe), (IIf), (IIIe), (IIIf), (IVe) and (IVf) above.
  • Representative aromatic bicyclic ring systems resulting from conjugated double bonds are depicted by structures (IIc), (IId), (IIIc), (IIId), (IVc) and (IVd) above.
  • bicyclic ring systems having structure (III) above.
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structures (IIIj), (IIIk) and (IIIl):
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structures (IIIm), (IIIn) and (IIIo):
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structures (IIIp), (IIIq), (IIIr) and (IIIr'):
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structure (IIIs): wherein A is selected from -(CH 2 ) 0-4 -, -(CH 2 ) 1-2 O- and -(CH 2 ) 1-2 S-; C is selected from -(CH 2 ) 0-3 -, -O-, -S-, -O(CH 2 ) 1-2 - and -S(CH 2 ) 1-2 -; and the bicyclic ring system is saturated.
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structure (IIIf):
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structures (IIIu) and (IIIv) :
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structure (IIIw): where A is selected from -(CH 2 ) 1-4 -, -(CH 2 ) 1-2 O- and -(CH 2 ) 1-2 S-.
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structures (IIIx) and (IIIy):
  • bicyclic ring systems having the following structures (IIIz) and (IIIza):
  • bicyclic ring systems having strucutre (IV) above.
  • B is CH or N
  • D is N and the optional carbonyl moiety is present, as represented by the following structures (IVg), (IVg'), (IVh) and (IVh'):
  • bicyclic ring systems having structures (V), (VI) and (VII) are disclosed.
  • bicyclic ring systems include the following structures (VIa), (VIb) and (VIc):
  • compounds of this invention include structures (IXc) through (IXh).
  • compounds of this invention include structures (Xc) and (Xd):
  • compounds of this invention include structure (XIc) :
  • bicyclic ring systems may be synthesized by one skilled in the art by known organic synthesis techniques.
  • the various embodiments of structure (I) may be synthesized according to the following reaction schemes.
  • Structure (IIIt) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
  • Structure (IIIw) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
  • the bicyclic ring system may contain adjacent CH groups ( i . e ., the bicyclic ring system may be formed, at least in part, by a -CH-CH- group).
  • Reaction Schemes (15), (16) and (17) illustrate further synthetic methodology for preparing representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (III).
  • structures (IVc) and (IVd) may be made by reaction scheme (19-1).
  • structure (IVf) may be made by the following reaction scheme (21-1).
  • Bicyclic ring systems of structures (V), (VI) and (VII) may be made by the same general techniques as disclosed above for compounds of structures (II), (III) and (IV), with the exception that the respective precursor intermediate does not contain a carbonyl moiety at position F.
  • Y groups have the structure: where a preferred stereochemistry is:
  • R 4 groups are organoamine moieties having from about 2 to about 10 carbon atoms and at least one nitrogen atom. Suitable organoamine moieties have the chemical formula C 2-10 H 4-20 N 1-6 O 0-2 ; and preferably have the chemical formula C 3-7 H 7-14 N 1-4 O 0-1 .
  • Exemplary organoamine moieties of the invention are (wherein R is selected from hydrogen, halogen ( e . g ., fluorine), lower chain alkyl ( e . g ., methyl), and hydroxy lower chain alkyl ( e.g., hydroxymethyl); and X is selected from CH 2 , NH, S and O):
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of the present invention may be used in standard peptide synthesis protocols, including automated solid phase peptide synthesis.
  • Peptide synthesis is a stepwise process where a peptide is formed by elongation of the peptide chain through the stepwise addition of single amino acids. Amino acids are linked to the peptide chain through the formation of a peptide (amide) bond. The peptide link is formed by coupling the amino group of the peptide to the carboxylic acid group of the amino acid. The peptide is thus synthesized from the carboxyl terminus to the amino terminus. The individual steps of amino acid addition are repeated until a peptide (or protein) of desired length and amino acid sequence is synthesized.
  • the amino group of the amino acid to be added to the peptide should not interfere with peptide bond formation between the amino acid and the peptide (i.e. , the coupling of the amino acid's carboxyl group to the amino group of the peptide).
  • the amino groups of the amino acids used in peptide synthesis are protected with suitable protecting groups.
  • suitable protecting groups include, for example, BOC and FMOC groups. Accordingly, in one embodiment of the present invention, the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of the present invention bear a free carboxylic acid group and a protected amino group, and are thus suitable for incorporation into a peptide by standard synthetic techniques.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention may be synthesized on solid support, typically via a suitable linker.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics may then be cleaved from the solid support by, for example, aminolysis, and screened as competitive substrates against appropriate agents, such as the chromogenic substrate BAPNA (benzyoylarginine paranitroanalide)( see Eichler and Houghten, Biochemistry 32 :11035-11041, 1993)(incorporated herein by reference).
  • appropriate agents such as the chromogenic substrate BAPNA (benzyoylarginine paranitroanalide)( see Eichler and Houghten, Biochemistry 32 :11035-11041, 1993)(incorporated herein by reference).
  • BAPNA benzyoylarginine paranitroanalide
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetic may be converted into an inhibitor by modifications to the C-terminal-that is, by modification to the Y moiety.
  • the terminal Y moiety may be replaced with -CH 2 Cl, -CF 3 ,-H, or -C(O)NHR.
  • Appropriate R moieties may be selected using a library of substrates, or using a library of inhibitors generated using a modification of the procedure of Wasserman and Ho ( J . Org. Chem. 59 :4364-4366, 1994) (incorporated herein by reference).
  • Libraries of compounds containing ⁇ -strand templates may be constructed to determine the optimal sequence for substrate recognition or binding. Representative strategies to use such libraries are discussed below.
  • a representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic substrate library may be constructed as follows. It should be understood that the following is exemplary of methodology that may be used to prepare a ⁇ -sheet mimetic substrate library, and that other libraries may be prepared in an analogous manner.
  • the complexity of the library generated by this technique is (R 1 ) (R 3 ) (R) (Y) .
  • R 1 , R 3 and R are selected from naturally occurring amino acid side chains moieties, n is constant, and Y is H, Ac or -SO 2 R as defined above, a library having on the order of 24,000 members [(20) (20) (20)(3)] is generated.
  • the library may then recovered and screened with a second target, and so on.
  • a specific target e.g., enzyme
  • a library of inhibitors can be constructed and screened in a standard chromogenic assay.
  • the library may be constructed as follows, where the following example is merely representative of the inhibitor libraries that may be prepared in an analogous manner to the specific example provided below.
  • a further alternative strategy is to link the library through the sidechain R group as shown below.
  • a library of aspartic protease inhibitors may be constructed having the following exemplary structure, and then cleaved from the resin and screened:
  • a library having the exemplary structure shown below may be constructed and then cleaved from the resin to provide a library of hydroxamic acids:
  • the activity of the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention may be further illustrated by reference to Table 2 which lists a number of biologically active peptides.
  • the peptides of Table 2 are known to have biological activity as substrates or inhibitors.
  • Biologically Active Peptides Protease Inhibitors (a) (D)FPR (Thrombin) Enzyme 40 :144-48, 1988 (b) (D)IEGR (Factor X) Handbook of Synthetic Substrates for the Coagulation and Fibronlytic Systems, H.C. Hemker, pp. 1-175, 1983, Martinus Nijhoff Publishers, The Hague.
  • Protein Kinase Substrates and Inhibitors (c) LRRASLG (Serine Kinase) Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun . 61 :559, 1974 (d) LPYA (Tyrosine Kinase) J . Bio. Chem. 263 :5024, 1988 (e) PKI (Serine Kinase) Science 253: 1414-20, 1991 CAAX Inhibitors: (f) (H)-CVIM-(OH) Proc . Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 88 :732-36, 1991 (g) (H)-CVFM-(OH) Bioorg. Med. Chem.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention can be synthesized to mimic any number of biologically active peptides by appropriate choice of the R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , F, Y and Z moieties (as well as the A, B, C, D and E moieties of structure (I) itself).
  • R 2 , R 2 ', R 3 , F, Y and Z moieties as well as the A, B, C, D and E moieties of structure (I) itself.
  • Table 3 which discloses various modifications which may be made to the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of structure (I) to yield biologically active compounds.
  • R 2 and R 3 are independently chosen from among the atoms or groups shown under the "R 2 /R 3 " column.
  • the structure of the resulting ⁇ -sheet modified peptide (prior to cleavage from the solid support, such as PAM) may be represented by the following diagram, where AA 1 through AA 3 represent the same or different amino acids:
  • the precise ⁇ -sheet mimetic may be chosen by any of a variety of techniques, including computer modeling, randomization techniques and/or by utilizing natural substrate selection assays.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetic may also be generated by synthesizing a library of ⁇ -sheet mimetics, and screening such library members to identify active members as disclosed above.
  • ⁇ -sheet mimetic modification may then be made to the various amino acids attached thereto.
  • a series of ⁇ -sheet modified peptides having a variety of amino acid substitutions are then cleaved from the solid support and assayed to identify a preferred substrate. It should be understood that the generation of such substrates may involve the synthesis and screening of a number of ⁇ -sheet modified peptides, wherein each ⁇ -sheet modified peptide has a variety of amino acid substitutions in combination with a variety of different ⁇ -sheet mimetics.
  • the Z moiety is AA 3 and the Y moiety is AA 2 and AA 1 in the above diagram.
  • AA 3 may be absent or additional amino acids my be joined thereto; and AA 2 and/or AA 1 may be omitted or additional amino acids may be joined thereto).
  • the substrate may be readily converted to an inhibitor by known techniques.
  • the C-terminal amino acid in this case AA 1
  • the C-terminal amino acid may be modified by addition of a number of moieties known to impart inhibitor activity to a substrate, including (but not limited to) -CF 3 (a known reversible serine protease inhibitor), -CH 2 Cl (a known irreversible serine protease inhibitor), -CHN 2 and -CH 2 S(CH 3 ) 2 + (known cysteinyl protease inhibitors), -NHOH (a known metalloprotease inhibitor), (a known cysteinyl protease inhibitor), and (a known aspartyl protease inhibitor).
  • -CF 3 a known reversible serine protease inhibitor
  • -CH 2 Cl a known irreversible serine protease inhibitor
  • -CHN 2 and -CH 2 S(CH 3 ) 2 + known cysteinyl protease inhibitors
  • -NHOH a
  • ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention While the utility of the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention have been disclosed with regard to certain embodiments, it will be understood that a wide variety and type of compounds can be made which includes the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of the present invention.
  • a ⁇ -sheet mimetic of this invention may be substituted for two or more amino acids of a peptide or protein.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention also serve to inhibit proteolytic breakdown. This results in the added advantage of peptides or proteins which are less prone to proteolytic breakdown due to incorporation of the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention have broad utility in naturally occurring or synthetic peptides, proteins and molecules.
  • peptides, proteins and molecules peptides, proteins and molecules.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics disclosed herein have activity as inhibitors of kinases and proteases, as well as having utility as MHC II inhibitors.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of this invention have activity as inhibitors of the large family of trypsin-like serine proteases, including those preferring arginine or lysine as a P' substituent.
  • These enzymes are involved in hemostasis and include (but are not limited to) Factor VIIa, Factor IXa, Factor Xa, Factor XIa, thrombin, kallikrein, urokinase (which is also involved in cancer metastasis) and plasmin.
  • a related enzyme, tryptase is involved in inflammatory responses.
  • the ability to selectively inhibit these enzymes has wide utility in therapeutic applications involving cardiovascular disease, inflammatory diseases, and oncology.
  • the present invention encompasses pharmaceutical compositions prepared for storage or administration which comprise a therapeutically effective amount of a ⁇ -sheet mimetic or compound of the present invention in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • Anticoagulant therapy is indicated for the treatment and prevention of a variety of thrombotic conditions, particularly coronary artery and cerebrovascular disease. Those experienced in this- field are readily aware of the circumstances requiring anticoagulant therapy.
  • the "therapeutically effective amount" of a compound of the present invention will depend on the route of administration, the type of warm-blooded animal being treated, and the physical characteristics of the specific animal under consideration. These factors and their relationship to determining this amount are well known to skilled practitioners in the medical arts. This amount and the method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which as noted those skilled in the medical arts will recognize.
  • the "therapeutically effective amount" of the compound of the present invention can range broadly depending upon the desired affects and the therapeutic indication. Typically, dosages will be between about 0.01 mg/kg and 100 mg/kg body weight, preferably between about 0.01 and 10 mg/kg, body weight.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers” for therapeutic use are well known in the pharmaceutical art, and are described, for example, in Remingtons Pharmaceutical Sciences, Mack Publishing Co. (A.R. Gennaro edit. 1985).
  • sterile saline and phosphate-buffered saline at physiological pH may be used.
  • Preservatives, stabilizers, dyes and even flavoring agents may be provided in the pharmaceutical composition.
  • sodium benzoate, sorbic acid and esters of p-hydroxybenzoic acid may be added as preservatives.
  • antioxidants and suspending agents may be used.
  • Thrombin inhibition is useful not only in the anticoagulant therapy of individuals having thrombotic conditions, but is useful whenever inhibition of blood coagulation is required such as to prevent coagulation of stored whole blood and to prevent coagulation in other biological samples for testing or storage.
  • the thrombin inhibitors can be added to or contacted with any medium containing or suspected of containing thrombin and in which it is desired that blood coagulation be inhibited ( e . g ., when contacting the mammal's blood with material selected from the group consisting of vascular grafts, stems, orthopedic prosthesis, cardiac prosthesis, and extracorporeal circulation systems).
  • the thrombin inhibitors can be co-administered with suitable anti-coagulation agents or thrombolytic agents such as plasminogen activators or streptokinase to achieve synergistic effects in the treatment of various vascular pathologies.
  • suitable anti-coagulation agents or thrombolytic agents such as plasminogen activators or streptokinase to achieve synergistic effects in the treatment of various vascular pathologies.
  • thrombin inhibitors enhance the efficiency of tissue plasminogen activator-mediated thrombolytic reperfusion.
  • Thrombin inhibitors may be administered first following thrombus formation, and tissue plasminogen activator or other plasminogen activator is administered thereafter. They may also be combined with heparin, aspirin, or warfarin.
  • the thrombin inhibitors of the invention can be administered in such oral forms as tablets, capsules (each of which includes sustained release or timed release formulations), pills, powders, granules, elixers, tinctures, suspensions, syrups, and emulsions. Likewise, they may be administered in intravenous (bolus or infusion), intraperitoneal, subcutaneous, or intramuscular form, all using forms well known to those of ordinary skill in the pharmaceutical arts. An effective but non-toxic amount of the compound desired can be employed as an anti-aggregation agent or treating ocular build up of fibrin. The compounds may be administered intraocularly or topically as well as orally or parenterally.
  • the thrombin inhibitors can be administered in the form of a depot injection or implant preparation which may be formulated in such a manner as to permit a sustained release of the active ingredient.
  • the active ingredient can be compressed into pellets or small cylinders and implanted subcutaneously or intramuscularly as depot injections or implants.
  • Implants may employ inert materials such as biodegradable polymers or synthetic silicones, for example, Silastic, silicone rubber or other polymers manufactured by the Dow-Corning Corporation.
  • the thrombin inhibitors can also be administered in the form of liposome delivery systems, such as small unilamellar vesicles, large unilamellar vesicles and multilamellar vesicles.
  • Liposomes can be formed from a variety of phospholipids, such as cholesterol, stearylamine or phosphatidylcholines.
  • the thrombin inhibitors may also be delivered by the use of monoclonal antibodies as individual carriers to which the compound molecules are coupled.
  • the thrombin inhibitors may also be coupled with soluble polymers as targetable drug carriers.
  • Such polymers can include polyvinlypyrrolidone, pyran copolymer, polyhydroxy-propyl-methacrylamide-phenol, polyhydroxyethyl-aspartarnide-phenol, or polyethyleneoxide-polylysine substituted with palmitoyl residues.
  • the thrombin inhibitors may be coupled to a class of biodegradable polymers useful in achieving controlled release of a drug, for example, polylactic acid, polyglycolic acid, copolymers of polylactic and polyglycolic acid, polyepsilon caprolactone, polyhydroxy butyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydibydropyrans, polycyanoacrylates and cross linked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.
  • biodegradable polymers useful in achieving controlled release of a drug
  • a drug for example, polylactic acid, polyglycolic acid, copolymers of polylactic and polyglycolic acid, polyepsilon caprolactone, polyhydroxy butyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydibydropyrans, polycyanoacrylates and cross linked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.
  • injectable pharmaceutical compositions can be prepared in conventional forms, either as liquid solutions or suspensions, solid forms suitable for solution or suspension in liquid prior to injection, or as emulsions.
  • Tablets suitable for oral administration of active compounds of the invention can be prepared as follows: Amount-mg Active Compound 25.0 50.0 100.0 Microcrystalline cellulose 37.25 100.0 200.0 Modified food corn starch 37.25 4.25 8.5 Magnesium stearate 0.50 0.75 1.5
  • All of the active compound, cellulose, and a portion of the corn starch are mixed and granulated to 10% corn starch paste.
  • the resulting granulation is sieved, dried and blended with the remainder of the corn starch and the magnesium stearate.
  • the resulting granulation is then compressed into tablets containing 25.0, 50.0, and 100.0 mg, respectively, of active ingredient per tablet.
  • An intravenous dosage form of the above-indicated active compounds may be prepared as follows: Active Compound 0.5-10.0mg Sodium Citrate 5-50mg Citric Acid 1-15mg Sodium Chloride 1-8mg Water for Injection (USP) q.s. to 1 ml
  • the active compound is dissolved at room temperature in a previously prepared solution of sodium chloride, citric acid, and sodium citrate in Water for Injection (USP, see page 1636 of United States Pharmacopoeia/National Formulary for 1995, published by United States Pharmacopoeia Convention, Inc., Rockville, Maryland, copyright 1994).
  • Compounds of the present invention when made and selected as disclosed are useful as potent inhibitors of thrombin in vitro and in vivo. As such, these compounds are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents to prevent the clotting of blood and as in vivo pharmaceutical agents to prevent thrombosis in mammals suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis.
  • the compounds of the present invention are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents for inhibiting clotting in blood drawing tubes.
  • the use of stoppered test tubes having a vacuum therein as a means to draw blood obtained by venipuncture into the tube is well known in the medical arts (Kasten, B.L., "Specimen Collection,” Laboratory Test Handbook, 2nd Edition, Lexi-Comp Inc., Cleveland pp. 16-17, Edits. Jacobs, D.S. et al. 1990).
  • Such vacuum tubes may be free of clot-inhibiting additives, in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian serum from the blood they may alternatively contain clot-inhibiting additives (such as heparin salts, EDTA salts, citrate salts or oxalate salts), in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian plasma from the blood.
  • clot-inhibiting additives such as heparin salts, EDTA salts, citrate salts or oxalate salts
  • the compounds of the present invention are potent inhibitors of factor Xa or thrombin, and as such, can be incorporated into blood collection tubes to prevent clotting of the mammalian blood drawn into them.
  • the compounds of the present invention may be used alone, in combination of other compounds of the present invention, or in combination with other known inhibitors of clotting, in the blood collection tubes.
  • the amount to be added to such tubes is that amount sufficient to inhibit the formation of a clot when mammalian blood is drawn into the tube.
  • the addition of the compounds to such tubes may be accomplished by methods well known in the art, such as by introduction of a liquid composition thereof, as a solid composition thereof, or liquid composition which is lyophilized to a solid.
  • the compounds of the present invention are added to blood collection tubes in such amounts that, when combined with 2 to 10 mL of mammalian blood, the concentration of such compounds will be sufficient to inhibit clot formation. Typically, the required concentration will be about 1 to 10,000 nM, with 10 to 1000 nM being preferred.
  • the compounds of this invention regulate transcription factors whose ability to bind to DNA is controlled by reduction of a cysteine residue by a cellular oxidoreductase.
  • the transcription factor is NF- ⁇ B.
  • the compounds of this invention have activity as mediators of immune and/or inflammatory responses, or serve to control cell growth.
  • the transcription factor is AP-1, and the cellular oxidoreductase is Ref-1.
  • the compounds of this invention have activity as anti-inflammatory and/or anticancer agents.
  • the transcription factor is selected from Myb and glucocorticoid receptor.
  • transcription factors that may be regulated within the context of this invention also include: those of the NFkB family, such as Rel-A, c-Rel, Rel-B, p50 and p52; those of the AP-1 family, such as Fos, FosB, Fra-1, Fra-2, Jun, JunB and JunD; ATF; CREB; STAT-1, -2, -3, -4, -5 and -6; NEAT-1, -2 and -4; MAF; Thyroid Factor; IRF; Oct-1 and -2; NF-Y; Egr-1; and USF-43.
  • NFkB such as Rel-A, c-Rel, Rel-B, p50 and p52
  • those of the AP-1 family such as Fos, FosB, Fra-1, Fra-2, Jun, JunB and JunD
  • ATF CREB
  • NEAT-1, -2 and -4 NEAT-1,
  • a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of this invention is administered to a warm-blooded animal in need thereof.
  • the compounds of this invention may be administered to a warm-blooded animal that has been diagnosed with, or is at risk of developing, a condition selected from Chrohns disease, asthma, rheumatoid arthritis, ischemia, reperfusion injury, graft versus host disease (GVHD), amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), Alzheimer's disease, allograft rejection and adult T-cell leukemia.
  • GVHD graft versus host disease
  • ALS amyotrophic lateral sclerosis
  • Alzheimer's disease allograft rejection and adult T-cell leukemia.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic of this intention.
  • Phenylalanine benzaldimine, structure (1) was synthesized as follows. To a mixture of L-phenylalanine methyl ester hydrochloride (7.19 g, 33.3 mmol) and benzaldehyde (3.4 ml, 33.5 mmol) stirred in CH 2 Cl 2 (150 ml) at room temperature was added triethylamine (7.0 ml, 50 mmol). Anhydrous magnesium sulfate (2 g) was added to the resulting solution and the mixture was stirred for 14 h then filtered through a 1 inch pad of Celite with CH 2 Cl 2 . The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to ca. one half of its initial volume then diluted with an equal volume of hexanes.
  • ⁇ -Allylphenylalanine benzaldimine, structure (2) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of diisopropylamine (4.3 ml, 33 mmol) stirred in THF (150 ml) at -78°C was added dropwise a solution of n -butyllithium (13 ml of a 2.5 M hexane solution, 33 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred for 20 min. then a solution of phenylalanine benzaldimine (7.97 g, 29.8 mmol) in THF (30 ml) was slowly added. The resulting dark red-orange solution was stirred for 15 min.
  • ⁇ -Allylphenylalanine hydrochloride structure (3), was synthesized as follows. To a solution of ⁇ -allylphenylalanine benzaldimine (5.94 g, 19.3 mmol) stirred in methanol (50 ml) was added 5% aqueous hydrochloric acid (10 ml). The solution was stirred at room temperature for 2 h then concentrated under vacuum to an orange-brown caramel. The crude product was dissolved in CHCl 3 (10 ml) and the solution was heated to boiling. Hexanes ( ⁇ 150 ml) were added and the slightly cloudy mixture was allowed to cool. The liquid was decanted away from the crystallized solid then the solid was rinsed with hexanes and collected. Removal of residual solvents under vacuum yielded 3.56 g (72%) of pure ⁇ -allylphenylalanine hydrochloride as a white crystalline solid.
  • N- tert -butyloxycarbonyl - ⁇ -allylphenylalanine, structure (4) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of D,L ⁇ -allylphenylalanine hydrochloride (565 mg, 2.21 mmol) stirred in a mixture of THF (15 ml) and water (5 ml) was added di- tert -butyl dicarbonate followed by careful addition of solid sodium bicarbonate in small portions. The resulting two phase mixture was vigorously stirred at room temperature for 2 days then diluted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was separated and washed with water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered.
  • An aldehyde of structure (5) was synthesized as follows. Ozone was bubbled through a solution of 2.10 g (6.57 mmol) of the structure (4) olefin stirred at -78°C in a mixture of CH 2 Cl 2 (50 ml) and methanol (15 ml) until the solution was distinctly blue in color. The solution was stirred an additional 15 min. then dimethyl sulfide was slowly added. The resulting colorless solution was stirred at -78°C for 10 min. then allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 6 h.
  • a hydrazone of structure (6) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the aldehyde of structure (5) (1.62 g, 5.03 mmol) stirred in THF (50 ml) at room temperature was added hydrazine hydrate (0.32 ml, 6.5 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 10 min. then heated to reflux for 3 days. The solution was allowed to cool to room temperature then concentrated under vacuum to 1.59 g (105% crude yield) of colorless foam. The crude hydrazone product, structure (6), was used without purification.
  • a cyclic hydrazide of structure (7) was synthesized as follows.
  • the crude hydrazone of structure (6) (55 mg, 0.18 mmol) and platinum oxide (5 mg, 0.02 mmol) were taken up in methanol and the flask was fitted with a three-way stopcock attached to a rubber balloon.
  • the flask was flushed with hydrogen gas three times, the balloon was inflated with hydrogen, and the mixture was stirred vigorously under a hydrogen atmosphere for 17 hours.
  • the mixture was filtered through Celite with ethyl acetate and the filtrate was concentrated under vacuum to a white form. Purification of the white foam by flash chromatography yielded 44 mg of the pure cyclic hydrazide of structure (7) (80%).
  • Structure (8) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the cyclic hydrazide of structure (7) (4.07 g, 13.32 mmol) stirred in ethyl acrylate (200 ml) at 90°C was added formaldehyde (1.2 mL of a 37% aqueous solution). The mixture was heated to reflux for 15 h then allowed to cool to room temperature and concentrated under vacuum to a white foam. The products were separated by column chromatography (5% then 10% acetone/chloroform) to yield 0.851 g of the least polar diastereomer of the bicyclic ester, structure (8b), and a more polar diastereomer (8a). The impure fractions were subjected to a second chromatography to afford more pure structure (8b), 25% combined yield.
  • Structure (9b) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the least polar ethyl ester (i.e. , structure (8b)) (31 mg, 0.074 mmol) stirred in THF (1 ml) was added aqueous lithium hydroxide (1 M , 0.15 ml). The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 h then the reaction was quenched with 5% aqueous citric acid. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x) then the combined extracts were washed with water and brine. The organic layer was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to a colorless glass. The crude acid, structure (9b), was used in subsequent experiments without further purification.
  • Structure (10b) was synthesized as follows. The crude acid of structure (9b) (30 mg, 0.074 mmol), HArg(PMC)pNA (41 mg, 0.074 mmol), and HOBt (15 mg, 0.098 mmol) were dissolved in THF (1 ml) then diisopropylethylamine (0.026 ml, 0.15 mmol) was added followed by EDC (16 mg, 0.084 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 4 h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine.
  • a ( ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (11b) was synthesized as follows. A solution of 0.25 ml of H 2 O, 0.125 ml of 1,2-ethanedithiol and 360 mg of phenol in 5 ml of TFA was prepared and the protected product of structure (10b) (33 mg, 0.035 mmol) was dissolved in 2 ml of this solution. The resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 3 h then concentrated under reduced pressure. Ether was added to the concentrate and the resulting precipitate was collected by centrifugation. The precipitate was triturated with ether and centrifuged two more times then dried in a vacuum desiccator for 14 h. The crude product (14 mg) was purified by HPLC chromatography to yield the ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (11b). MS (CI+, NH 3 ) m/z 954.8 (M + Na + ).
  • Structure (12b) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the crude acid of structure (9b) (24 mg, 0.062 mmol) and N-methylmorpholine (0.008 ml), stirred in THF (1 ml) at -50°C was added isobutyl chloroformate. The resulting cloudy mixture was stirred for 10 min. then 0.016 ml (0.14 mmol) of N-methylmorpholine was added followed by a solution of HArg(Mtr)CH 2 Cl (50 mg, 0.068 mmol) in THF (0.5 ml). The mixture was kept at -50°C for 20 min. then was allowed to warm to room temperature during 1 h.
  • a ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (13b) was synthesized as follows.
  • the more polar diastereomer of structure (12b) (16 mg, 0.021 mmol) was dissolved in 95% TFA/H 2 O (1 ml) and the resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 6 h then concentrated under vacuum to 11 mg of crude material.
  • the crude product was triturated with ether and the precipitate was washed twice with ether then dried under high vacuum for 14 h.
  • 1 H NMR analysis indicated a 1:1 mixture of fully deprotected product and product containing the Mtr protecting group.
  • the mixture was dissolved in 95% TFA/H 2 O and stirred for 2 days and the product was recovered as above. Purification of the product by HPLC yielded 5 mg of the pure compound of structure (13b). MS (EI+) m/z 477.9 (M + ).
  • N,O-Dimethyl hydroxamate, structure (14), was synthesized as follows. To a mixture of Boc-N g -4-methoxy-2,3,6-trimethylbenzenesulfonyl-L-arginine (8.26 g, 14.38 mmol), N,O-dimethylhydroxylamine hydrochloride (2.78 g, 28.5 mmol) and 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (2.45 g, 16.0 mmol) stirred in THF (150 ml) at ambient temperature was added N,N-diisopropylethylamine (7.5 ml, 43 mmol) followed by solid EDC (3.01 g, 15.7 mmol).
  • the arginal, structure (16) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the arginine amide structure (15) stirred in toluene at -78°C under a dry argon atmosphere was added a solution of diisobutylaluminum hydride in toluene (1.0 M , 7.3ml) dropwise over a period of 15 minutes. The resulting solution was stirred for 30 minutes then a second portion of diisobutylaluminum hydride (3.5ml) was added and stirring was continued for 15 minutes. Methanol (3ml) was added dropwise and the solution was stirred at -78°C for 10 minutes then allowed to warm to room temperature.
  • the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate (100ml) and stirred vigorously with 50 ml of saturated aqueous potassium sodium tartrate for 2.5h.
  • the aqueous phase was separated and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 100ml).
  • the extracts were combined with the original organic solution and shaken with brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded a white foam that was separated by flash chromatography to yield 1.617g of the aldehyde as a white foam.
  • Hydroxybenzothiazole structure (17), was synthesized as follows. To a solution of benzothiazole (1.55 ml, 14 mmol) stirred in anhydrous diethyl ether (60 ml) at -78°C under a dry argon atmosphere was added a solution of n -butyllithium (2.5 M in hexane, 5.6 ml, 14 mmol) dropwise over a period of 10 minutes. The resulting orange solution was stirred for 45 minutes then a solution of the arginal structure (16) (1.609 g, 2.819 mmol) in diethyl ether (5ml) was slowly added.
  • the bicyclic compound, structure (18b) was synthesized as follows.
  • the bicyclic acid of structure (9b) from Example 1 151 mg, 0.387 mmol
  • HOBt hydrate 71 mg, 0.46 mmol
  • diisopropylethylamine 0.34 ml, 1.9 mmol
  • EDC 89 mg, 0.46 mmol
  • a solution of the benzothiazolylarginol trifluoroacetic acid salt structure (17) 273 mg, 0.372 mmol
  • THF 0.5 ml
  • the ketobenzothiazole, structure (20), was synthesized as follows. Ketobenzothiazole (19) (41 mg, 0.047 mmol) was dissolved in 95% aqueous trifluoroacetic (0.95 ml) acid and thioanisole (0.05 ml) was added. The resulting dark solution was stirred for 30 hours at room temperature then concentrated under vacuum to a dark brown gum. The gum was triturated with diethyl ether and centrifuged. The solution was removed and the solid remaining was triturated and collected as above two more times. The yellow solid was dried in a vacuum desiccator for 2 hours then purified by HPLC (Vydac reverse phase C-4 column (22 x 250 mm ID).
  • This example illustrates the ability of a representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention to selectively serve as a substrate for thrombin and Factor VII.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (11b) above was synthesized according the procedures disclosed in Example 1, and used in this experiment without further modification.
  • Factor VII assay pH 8.0 Tris buffer (0.05 M Tris, 5 mM CaCl 2 , 0.15 M NaCl, 0.1% TWEEN 20, 0.1% BSA) was used. 10 ⁇ l of 20 ⁇ M human Factor VIIa (FVIIa) and 22 ⁇ M of human tissue factor (TF) was brought to assay buffer to make 160 nM FVIIa and TF solutions, respectively. 40 to 48 ⁇ l of buffer, 25 ⁇ l of FVIIa and 25 ⁇ l TF solution were added to a cuvette, and incubated at 37°C for 5 minutes, then 2 to 10 ⁇ l of 2.4 mM structure (11b) solution was added to the cuvette to initiate reaction (final volume was 100 ml).
  • Tris buffer 0.05 M Tris, 5 mM CaCl 2 , 0.15 M NaCl, 0.1% TWEEN 20, 0.1% BSA
  • the initial 3 minutes reaction progress curves were recorded.
  • Five structure (11b) concentration points were collected.
  • the initial rates were linear least-square fitted against the concentrations of structure (11b) with GraFit.
  • the k cat /K M was calculated from the slope and found to be 17,500 M -1 s -1 .
  • This example illustrates the ability of a representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention to function as a protease inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, urokinase, tissue plasminogen activator (t-PA), protein C, plasmin and trypsin.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (13b) above was synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Example 1, and used in this experiment.
  • N-p-tosyl-Gly-Pro-Arg-pNA (from Sigma) was used at 0.5 mM concentration in 1% DMSO (v/v) pH 8.4 Tris buffer as substrate.
  • 1% DMSO v/v
  • pH 8.4 Tris buffer 1% DMSO
  • 100 ⁇ l of 10 nM thrombin solution and 50 ⁇ l of structure (13b) solution was added. The mixture of the enzyme and inhibitor was incubated for 20 minutes, then 100 ⁇ l of 0.5 mM substrate solution was added to initiate the reaction.
  • buffer and substrate are the same as used for thrombin assay.
  • a 1:100 dilution was made into pH 8.4 Tris buffer to serve as the first point.
  • Seven dilutions with a dilution factor of 2 were made.
  • the assay protocol is the same as for thrombin except 25 nM of bovine factor Xa (from Sigma) in pH 8.4 Tris buffer was used instead of thrombin.
  • IC 50 of structure (13b) against factor X was found to be 385 ⁇ 17 nM.
  • buffer was pH 8.8 0.05 M Tris and 0.05 M NaCl in deionized water.
  • S-2444 from Sigma
  • pyroGlu-Gly-Arg-pNA at 0.5 mM in water was utilized as substrate.
  • the same dilution procedure was used as for Factor VII and Factor X.
  • Assay protocol is the same as for thrombin except 18.5 nM of human urokinase (from Sigma) was utilized.
  • IC 50 was found to be 927 ⁇ 138 nM.
  • Tissue Plasminogen Activator Buffer, substrate and the dilution scheme of structure (13b) were the same as utilized for Factor VII assay.
  • Activated Protein C Buffer was the same as used in thrombin assay. 1.25 mM S-2366 in the assay buffer was utilized as substrate. Dilutions of structure (13b) were the same as in urokinase assay.
  • Plasmin Buffer ( see thrombin assay); S-2551 (from Pharmacia), D-Val-Leu-Lys-pNA at 1.25 mM in assay buffer was utilized as substrate. For dilutions of structure (13b) ( see urokinase assay).
  • test compound i.e., PPACK or structure (13b)
  • This example illustrates the ability of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, urokinase, Tissue Plasminogen Activator, Activated Protein C, plasmin, tryptase and trypsin.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (20b) above was synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Example 2, and used in this experiment.
  • Thrombin N-p-tosyl-Gly-Pro-Arg-pNA (from Sigma) was used at 0.5 mM concentration in 1% DMSO (v/v) pH8.0 tris buffer (tris, 50 mM, TWEEN 20, 0.1%, BSA, 0.1%, NaCl, 0.15 M, CaCl 2 , 5 mM) as substrate. From structure (20b) stock solution two steps of dilution were made, first, 1:100 dilution in water, then 1:50 dilution in the pH8.0 tris buffer to serve as the first point (200 nM). Seven sequential dilutions were made from the first point for the assay.
  • D-Ile-Pro-Arg-pNA was used at 2.05 mM in the pH 8.0 tris buffer ( see thrombin assay). From the stock of structure (20b), a 1:100 dilution was made in the tris buffer. From this concentration point seven more sequential dilutions were made for the assay.
  • Factor X Buffer and substrate were the same as used for thrombin assay. A 1:100 dilution was made -in the pH8.0 tris buffer to serve as the first point. Seven more dilutions from the first were made for the assay.
  • Tissue Plasminogen Activator Buffer, substrate and the dilution scheme of structure (20b) were the same as utilized for Factor VII assay.
  • Activated Protein C Buffer was the same as used in thrombin assay. 1.25 mM S-2366 in the assay buffer was utilized as substrate. Dilutions of structure (20b) were the same as in urokinase assay.
  • Plasmin Buffer ( se e thrombin assay); S-2251 (from Pharmacia), D-Val-Leu-Lys-pNA at 1.25 mM in assay buffer was utilized as substrate. For dilutions of structure (20b) ( see urokinase assay).
  • 10 mM solution was made in water, then 1 mM solution was made in buffer from the 10 mM solution to serve as the first concentration point. From this point seven more dilutions were made for the assay.
  • Trypsin Buffer, substrate and the dilution scheme of structure (20b) were the same as used for thrombin.
  • K i (nM) Enzyme Source Assay Conc.(nM) Structure
  • thrombin bovine plasma 2 0.66 factor VII human 4 270 factor X bovine plasma 8 966 urokinase human kidney 3.7 600 t-PA human 10 495 APC human plasma 1 3320 plasmin bovine plasma 4 415 tryptase human lung 2 12.4 trypsin bovine pancreas 5 0.64
  • structure (20b) functioned as a good thrombin inhibitor, with good specificity against fibrinolytic enzymes.
  • Structure (21) was synthesized as follows. A solution of 48 mg (0.859 mmol) N a -FMOC-N e -Cbz-a-ethanal-Lys-Ome [synthesized from N e -Cbz-Lys-OMe by the same method used for the preparation of structure (5) from Phe-OMe], 15.9 mg (0.0859 mmol) Cys-OEt.HCl and 13.2 ⁇ L (0.0945 mmol) TEA were in 0.43 mL CH 2 Cl 2 were stirred under Ar for 2 hr at room temperature. Bis(bis(trimethylsilyl)amino)tin(II) (39.8 ⁇ L) was added and the reaction stirred overnight.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (24) was synthesized as follows. To a stirred solution of 1,1,1,3,3,3-hexamethyldisilazane (2.1 ml, 10 mmol) in THF (10 ml) was added n-BuLi (4 ml of 2.5M in hexane, 10 mmol) at 0°C. The resulting solution was stirred at the same temperature for 30 min. After cooling to -78°C, to this stirred solution was added a solution of carboxylic acid (23) (1.02 g, 3.94 mmol) in THF (10 ml) followed by rinsings of the addition syringe with 5 ml THF.
  • carboxylic acid (23) (1.02 g, 3.94 mmol
  • Structure (28a) was synthesized as follows.
  • the bicyclic acid (27a) (26 mg, 0.067 mmol), benzothiazolylarginol trifluoroacetic acid salt (structure (17) 61 mg, 0.083 mmol)
  • EDC 21 mg, 0.11 mmol
  • HOBt hydrate (16 mg, 0.10 mmol) were dissolved in THF (5 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.34 ml, 1.9 mmol) was added.
  • the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 15h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted sequentially with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine.
  • a ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (29a) was synthesized as follows.
  • the crude hydroxybenzothiazole (28a) (60 mg, 0.068 mmol) was dissolved in CH 2 Cl 2 (2 ml) and Dess-Martin periodinane (58 mg, 0.14 mmol) was added.
  • the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 6h then diluted with ethyl acetate and stirred vigorously with 10% aqueous sodium thiosulfate for 10 minutes.
  • the organic solution was separated and extracted with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 42 mg of yellow glass.
  • 1 H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of two diastereomeric ketobenzothiazoles.
  • This example illustrates the ability of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, Factor XI, and trypsin.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of structures (29a) and (29b) above were synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Example 7, and used in this experiment.
  • This example illustrates the ability of further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetics not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, Factor XI, tryptase, aPC, plasmin, tPA, urokinase and trypsin.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of structures (20) and (29b) above were synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Examples 2 and 7, respectively, and used in this experiment.
  • Example 8 The proteinase inhibitor assays were performed as described in Example 5 except as described in Example 8 for Factor XI. The results are presented in Table 8.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (30) was synthesized as follows. n-Butyllithium (700 ⁇ L, 1.75 mmol, 2.5M in hexanes) was added over 5 min to a solution of tris(methylthio)methane (256 ⁇ L, 1.95 mmol) in THF (1 ml) at -78 °C. The mixture was stirred for 40 min then treated with a solution of bis-Boc-argininal (structure (16) from Example 2) (100 mg, 1.75 mmol) in 2 ml THF, dropwise, over a period of 5 min. After stirring for 1.5 h, the reaction was quenched with saturated NH 4 Cl solution and allowed to warm to room temperature.
  • Structure (31) was synthesized as follows. A mixture of 77 mg (0.11 mmol) of the orthothiomethyl ester (structure (30)), 117 mg (0.43 mmol) of mercuric chloride, and 39 mg (0.18 mmol) of mercuric oxide in 2.5 ml of 12:1 methanol/water was stirred at rt for 4 h. The mixture was filtered through Celite and the residue washed with EtOAc (3x). The filtrate was diluted with water and extracted with EtOAc (3x). The organic layer was washed twice with 75% NH 4 OAc/NH 4 Cl, then with NH 4 Cl and dried (Na 2 SO 4 ).
  • Structure (32) was synthesized as follows. A solution of 32 mg of the methyl ester (structure (31)) (0.051 mmol) in THF/water (4 ml, 1:3) was treated with 5 mg (0.119 mmol) of LiOH ⁇ H 2 O. After stirring for 45 min, the reaction was diluted with 5% citric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (3x). The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over Na 2 SO 4 and concentrated to give 30 mg (96%) of structure (32) as a white solid. The product was used without further purification.
  • Structure (33) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the compound of structure (32) (29 mg, 0.047 mmol), HOBt (8 mg, 0.056 mmol) and EDC (11 mg, 0.056 mmol) in THF (5 ml), phenethylamine (7 ml, 0.056 mmol) was added followed by diisopropylethylamine (12 ⁇ L, 0.071 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at rt overnight and diluted with 5% citric acid. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous phase extracted with EtOAc (3x). The combined extracts were washed with a saturated solution of NaHCO 3 , brine, dried over Na 2 SO 4 , and filtered.
  • Structure (34) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of phenethylamide (structure (33), 25 mg, 0.035 mmol) in THF (5 ml) was added 18 mg of p-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (0.093 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at rt overnight to give a baseline spot by TLC. The solution was concentrated in vacuo, and the residue washed twice with ether removing excess pTsOH to give structure (34) as a yellowish-white solid, which was used without further purification. 1 H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl 3 ) was consistent with the expected product, however, individual peak assignment was difficult due to broadening. MS (ES+) m / z 520.4 (M+H + ).
  • Structure (34) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (35) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (36) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (37) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (38) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to structure (34) starting with p-chlorophenethylamine and structure (32).
  • 1 H NMR 500 MHz, CDCl 3
  • MS m/z 554.5 (M+H + ).
  • Structure (38) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (39) as'identified in Table 9 below.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (40) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (41) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (42) was prepared as follows. In a 10 ml round-bottomed flask were added CH 2 Cl 2 (10 ml), methyl 2,3 -dimethylaminopropionate dihydrochloride (19.9 mg, 0.103 mmol, 1.5 eq), and diisopropylethylamine (53 ml, 0.304 mmol, 4.4 eq). This suspension was stirred magnetically at room temperature for 1 h at which time was added the compound of structure (30) (50 mg, 0.068 mmol, 1 eq), mercury(II)chloride (82.4 mg, 0.304 mmol, 4.4 eq), and mercury(II)oxide (25.7 mg, 0.120 mmol, 1.7 eq).
  • the resulting yellow suspension was stirred for 16.5 h during which time the suspension turned gray.
  • the reaction was diluted with CH 2 Cl 2 (50 ml), washed with saturated aqueous NH 4 Cl (5 ml), saturated aqueous NaCl (5 ml) and dried over Na 2 SO 4 .
  • the cloudy suspension was filtered and the solvent removed in vacuo.
  • Structure (43) was synthesized as follows. In a 25 ml round-bottomed flask was placed the compound of structure (42) (230 mg, 0.33 mmol), CHCl 3 (5 ml) and MnO 2 (500 mg, 5.75 mmol, 17.4 eq). After stirring for 5 h the suspension was filtered and the solid washed with methanol. The solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (5 ml) and methanol (1 ml) and a fresh portion of MnO 2 (500 mg) was introduced and the reaction stirred for 15 h at room temperature. The solid was filtered and the solvent removed in vacuo .
  • Structure (44) was synthesized by the same method used to construct structure (33) to structure (34). The product was used in the coupling without further purification.
  • Structure (44) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the deprotection of structure (19) respectively) to provide structure (45) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • the coupling step was performed with the carbonyl compound of structure (44), rather than with the analogous hydroxy compound.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (46) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to structure (17) starting from structure (16) and thiazole. This compound was used in the coupling step without further purification.
  • Structure (46) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (47) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Structure (49) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to structure (17) starting from structure (48) and benzothiazole. This compound was used as a 1:1 mixture of diastereomers in the coupling step (described below) without further purification.
  • the foam was dissolved in CH 3 CN and diethylamine was added. The solution was stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes then concentrated under vacuum to a yellow foam. The foam was rinsed with hexanes and dissolved in DMF (0.5 ml). In a separate flask, carbonyldiimidazole (16 mg, 0.99 mmol) and guanidine hydrochloride (10 mg, 0.10 mmol) were dissolved in DMF (1 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.035 ml, 0.20 mmol) was added followed by DMAP (1 mg). The solution was stirred for 1.5 h at room temperature then the solution of amine was added and stirring was continued for 16 h.
  • Structure (50) was oxidized to provide the corresponding ketone of structure (51).
  • This example illustrates the ability of further representative ⁇ -sheet mimetics not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, Factor XI, tryptase, aPC, plasmin, tPA, urokinase thrombin thrombomodulin complex and trypsin.
  • the ⁇ -sheet mimetics of the structures listed in Table 9 had the inhibition activities shown in Table 10.
  • the proteinase inhibitor assays were performed as described in Example 9.
  • the assay for thrombin-thrombomodulin complex was conducted as for thrombin except that prior to the addition of inhibitor and substrate, thrombin was preincubated with 4 nM thrombomodulin for 20 minutes at room temperature.
  • Structure (52) may be synthesized employing the following intermediate (53) in place of intermediate (16) in Example 2:
  • intermediate (53) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
  • structure (57) was synthesized, and structure (58) may be synthesized, by the techniques disclosed herein.
  • structure (58) to bind to the SH2 domain of STAT6, or of structure (57) to bind the SH2 domain of the protein tyrosine phosphatase SH-PTP1 can be demonstrated by the procedures disclosed by Payne et al. ( PNAS 90 :4902-4906, 1993). Libraries of SH2 binding mimetics may be screened by the procedure of Songyang et al. ( Cell 72 :767-778, 1993).
  • structure (59) to act as a substrate or inhibitor of protein kinases may be demonstrated by the procedure of Songyang et al. ( Current Biology 4 :973-982, 1994).
  • This example illustrates the bioavailability of the compound of structure (20b) as synthesized in Example 2 above, and having the biological activity reported in Example 9 above.
  • Structure (64) was synthesized as follows. A 150 ml round bottom flask was charged with 5.19 grams (24.7 mmol) of 1,2,3-benzene tricarboxylic acid, 75 ml of toluene, and 3.3 mL (24.7 mmol) of triethyl amine. The reaction was heated at reflux for 3 hours with the azeotropic removal water. At this time 2.07 ml of aniline was added, and the reaction again refluxed for six hours with the azeotropic removal of water. Upon cooling the reaction solution a crystalline product formed and was filtered off (4.68 g).
  • Structure (65) was synthesized as follows.
  • the imide-acid of structure (64) (53.4 mg, 0.2 mmol) in THF (2 ml) was cooled to -40 °C and treated with 24.2 ⁇ l (0.22 mmol) of NMM and 28.2 ⁇ l IBCF (0.22 mmol).
  • the reaction was stirred for 3 minutes and then 0.69 ml (0.69 mmol) of a 1 M solution of diazomethane in ether was added.
  • the temperature was slowly raised to -20 degrees, and the reaction stirred for 2 h at this temperature.
  • the reaction was warmed to 0 °C and stirred for 3 h more.
  • Structure (66) was synthesized as follows. To a stirred suspension of 910 mg (5.14 mmol) of 4-phenyl urazole in 50 ml of methylene chloride, was added 1.654 g (5.14 mmol) of iodobenzene diacetate. A deep red color developed, and with stirring, all material went into solution. After stirring for 15 minutes at room temperature, 560 mg of 90% pure 2,4-penatdienoic acid was added and the color gradually faded as a white solid formed. After fifteen minutes an additional 70 mg of pentadienoic acid was added. After stirring for 2 h at room temperature, the methylene chloride was removed under reduced pressure.
  • Structure (67) was synthesized as follows.
  • the Diels-Alder adduct of structure (66) (432 mg, 1.57 mmol) was mixed with 150 mg 10% Pd/C in 50 ml MeOH.
  • the reaction was stirred overnight under a hydrogen atmosphere (hydrogen balloon). After 18 h, an aliquot (1 ml) was removed and the solvent evaporated under reduced pressure. 1 H NMR of the residue showed greater than 95% conversion to the saturated product.
  • the reaction mixture was filtered through celite, and the solvent removed via rotary evaporator, to give 424 mg of crystalline product.
  • Structure (68) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of 450 mg (1.64 mmol) of (67) in 40 ml of methylene chloride was added 142 ⁇ L of oxalyl chloride (1.64 mmol) and a drop of DMF. The reaction was stirred at room temperature overnight under Ar. The methylene chloride was removed via rotary evaporator and 30 ml of THF added. This solution was cooled to -20 degrees and 2 ml of a 1 M solution of diazomethane in ether added. This was stirred 4 h, while gradually warming to room temperature. The reaction was then cooled to -78 degrees, and 500 uL of 4 M HCl in dioxane added.
  • Structure (69) was synthesized as follows. To 4-phenyl urazole (1.179 g, 6.65 mmol) in 60 ml methylene chloride 2.14 g of iodobenzene diacetate (6.64 mmol) was added and the reaction mixture stirred at room temperature. A deep red color developed as all the solids gradually dissolved. After about 15 minutes, 640 mg of sorbinal (6.66 mmol) in 10 ml methylene chloride was added to the reaction flask, and the red color slowly faded. After two hours, the methylene chloride was removed under reduced pressure. Ether (30 ml) was added to the resulting residue, and cooled to -20 degrees overnight.
  • the crude alcohol was dissolved in 40 ml dichloromethane and 2.0 grams (4.7 mmol) of Dess-Martin periodinane reagent were added at room temperature. The reaction was stirred for 2 h, diluted with 40 ml dichloromethane and washed with 3 x 20 ml 1:1 (by volume) solution of 10% sodiumbicarbonate and 10% sodiumthiosulfate, 1 x 40 ml water, 1 x 40 ml brine and dried over magnesium sulfate. Filtration, solvent evaporation, and flash chromatography using 30% EtOAc/hexanes afforded the pure aldehyde (0.5 g, 67% 2 steps).
  • Example 25 the compounds of Example 25 were assayed for inhibition of TNF induced V-CAM expression in human umbilical vein entothelial cells (HUVEC).
  • HUVEC Upon stimulation with inflammatory cytokines, HUVEC express cell surface adhesion molecules, including E-selectin, V-CAM, and I-CAM.
  • Proteasome antagonists inhibit TNF ⁇ induced expression of these adhesion molecules, thereby providing a mechanism for regulating leucocyte adhesion and the inflammatory response.
  • compounds (65), (68), (69) and (71) were assayed by the procedures set forth by Deisher, Kaushansky and Harlan ("Inhibitors of Topoisomerase II Prevent Cytokine-Induced Expression of Vascular Cell Adhesion Molecule-1, While Augmenting the Expression of Endothelial Leukocyte Adhesion Molecule-1 on Human Umbilical Vein Endothelial Cells," Cell Adhesion Commun . 1 :133-42, 1993) (incorporated herein by reference), with the exception that tetramethyl benzidine was used in place of o-phenylenediamine-peroxide.
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of linkers used in the solid-phase synthesis of ⁇ -sheet mimetics.
  • the combined organic layers were dried over Na 2 SO 4 /MgSO 4 and filtered through a pad of silica gel.
  • the solvents were removed in vacuo and the residue purified two successive times on silica gel, the first time eluting with 7:3 ethyl acetate/hexane, and the second time eluting with 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexane, then 7:3 ethyl acetate/hexane.
  • the homogeneous mixture was magnetically stirred at room temperature for 6.5 h at which time 5% HCl (0.34 mL, 0.55 mmol) and ethyl acetate (10 mL) were added.
  • the organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer extracted with 2 ⁇ 10 mL ethyl acetate.
  • the combined organic layers were washed with saturated NaCl and dried over Na 2 SO 4 .
  • the arginol ester derivative (42) (1.35 g, 1.93 mmol) was dissolved in 70 mL of EtOAc at room temperature. To the solution was added manganese (IV) dioxide (5 g, 89.2 mmol) and the suspension was stirred vigorously for 5 h at room temperature after which time it was filtered through silica gel. The solvent was removed and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (30% hexane/EtOAc) to give the desired alcohol (76) (0.23 g, 18%) and the ketone (0.153 g, 11.5%).
  • the ester (76) (70 mg, 0.1 mmol) was dissolved in a mixture of THF (10 mL) and water (10 mL). To the solution was added LiOH (18 mg, 4.3 mmol) and the solution was heated to reflux for 7 h. The resulting solution was evaporated. The residue was dissolved in water and extracted with ether. The aqueous layer was evaporated. The resulting residue was dissolved in MeOH, and Dowex resin (50W ⁇ 8, H + form) was added to acidify the solution. The resin was filtered off, and the filtrate was evaporated to furnish the acid (35 mg, 60%).
  • the iminophosphorane (79) was suspended in THF/H 2 O (320 mL : 190 mL) and 2N HCl (64 mL) was added and the reaction was heated at reflux for 5 h. Concentrated HCl (11 mL) was added and reflux continued for an additional 20 h. The solvents were removed under vacuo and the resultant off-white solid was dried under high vacuum for 2 h (18.0 g) and used in the next step without further purification.
  • CMTPP cyanomethyl triphenylphosphonium chloride
  • the compound of structure (87) (16 g, 21.3 mmol) was dissolved in 100 mL of MeOH and cooled to -78°C. Ozone was bubbled through the reaction solution with a gas dispersion tube for 3 h. The product was isolated by removal of MeOH under reduced pressure and was purified on a silica gel column (200 g dry weight) equilibrated in a mobile phase of ethyl acetate/hexane (3:7). The product was eluted with ethyl acetate/hexane (4:6), and gave after drying 5.1 g (47% for the two steps). MS (ES+) 511 (M+H + ).
  • the keto ester (88) (5.1g, 9.8 mmol) was dissolved in 100 mL of THF. After the addition of tetramethylammonium borohydride (1.4 g, 11.8 mmol) to the solution, the vessel was sealed and stirred for 4 h. The reaction was incomplete at this point and more borohydride (0.21 g, 2.4mmol) was added and stirring was continued for an additional h. The reaction mixture was concentrated to an oil in vacuo and applied to a silica gel column (150g dry weight) equilibrated and eluted with ethyl acetate/hexane (4:6) to give 2.7 g (53%) of product. MS (ES+) 513 (M+H + ).
  • the hydroxy ester (89) (2.7 g, 5.3 mmol) was dissolved in 100 mL of THF and cooled to 0° - 5°C.
  • 0.2N LiOH (66.5 mL, 13.3 mmol) was added to the chilled solution and stirred for thirty minutes. The reaction was incomplete at that time and more 0.2N LiOH (10.4 mL, 2.1 mmol) was added.
  • the reaction was stirred of another thirty minutes and then quenched with 300 mL of ethyl acetate/0.2N HCl (2:1). The aqueous phase was separated, washed with 100 mL of ethyl acetate and the combined organic extracts were dried over magnesium sulfate and filtered.
  • the compound of structure ( 92 ) (18.03 g, 68.0 mmol) was suspended in 190 mL of 4 N KOH and heated to reflux for 2 hours. Upon cooling, the now clear pink solution was extracted with ether (6 ⁇ ) and acidified with concentrated HCl. The precipitate was collected by vacuum filtration, washed with water and EtOAc, and dried in vacuo overnight to yield 14.00 g of white solid (88%).
  • urazoles may be recrystallized from MeOH or another suitable solvent system.
  • This example illustrates the solid phase synthesis of representative ⁇ -sheet mimetics (100) through (227) (Tables 11-15).
  • Compounds Nos. 101, 119-121, 154, 163-167, 169, 172, 183, 184, 205, 226, 227-1 through 227-10 and 227-12 through 227-14 are according to this invention, while the remaining compounds are shown for purpose of comparison.
  • the compounds of this example were synthesized according to the following reaction scheme:
  • Fmoc-Leu or another amino acid was attached to the resin prior to the thiazole- (75) or imidazole-based (77) linkers via the same methodology.
  • the isocyanate (91) was coupled to Wang resin overnight in the presence of catalytic HCl in dichloromethane.
  • Deprotection of all Fmoc-protected linkers was effected by treatment with 25% piperidine in DMF, and deprotection the Boc-protected linker (77) was effected by TMS-Cl (1 M) and phenol (3 M) in dichloromethane for 30 min.
  • the lysinol derivative (90) was coupled to resin-bound linkers N-Fmoc-4-aminomethylbenzoic acid, (81), or (86) using PyBOP, HOBt and Hunigs' base in DMF until a negative Kaiser test was achieved. Treatment of the resin with 25% piperidine in DMF then cleaved the FMOC group. Following washing with DMF a dienoic acid was coupled to the resin-bound linkers using PyBOP, HOBt and Hunigs' base in DMF until the result of a Kaiser test was negative.
  • the cycloaddition was performed by pretreatment of a solution of a pyrazolidinedione (not shown) or urazole in DMF with a solution of [bis(trifluoroacetoxy)iodo]benzene in DMF.
  • the polymer-supported diene was treated with the resulting solution for 2-16 hours.
  • the resin was then washed with DMF and CH 2 Cl 2 .
  • Oxidation to the ketoamide was effected by treatment of the resin with a solution of Dess-Martin periodinane in DMSO for 60 min.
  • the resin was washed with CH 2 Cl 2 and the product was cleaved from the resin by treatment of the resin with 95:5 TFA:H 2 O for 1-12 h.
  • This example further illustrates the synthesis of representative ⁇ -sheet mimetics not according to this invention.
  • Methyl-2,4-dioxo-pentanoate (14.4 g, 0.10 mol) and 10.6 g of trimethyl orthoacetate were dissolved in 100 mL of methanol followed by the addition of 300 ⁇ L of acetyl chloride. This solution was then stirred at room temperature for 6 h. An aliquot was then taken and the solvent removed using a rotary evaporator. 1 H NMR analysis of the residue suggested a complete conversion to the methyl enol ether. The reaction solution was evaporated in vacuo. By 1 H NMR, purity was 90%, and the material was used for the next step without purification.
  • This example further illustrates the synthesis of representative ⁇ -sheet mimetics not according to this invention.
  • compounds (231) and (233) of Example 31 were assayed for their ability to block insulin disulfide reduction by thioredoxin.
  • Thioredoxin has been shown to up-regulate NF-kB for DNA binding by reduction of a disulfide bond involving Cys62 of the p50 subunit of NF-kB.
  • Thioredoxin is also known to reduce the disulfide bonds in insulin 10 4 times faster than low molecular weight thiols (Holmgren, J. Biol. Chem . 254 :9627-9632, 1979) (incorporated herein by reference).
  • an inhibitor of NF-kB activation is acting via inhibition of thioredoxin, it should also be able to block reduction of insulin by thioredoxin.
  • the following assay measures spectrophotometrically the increasing turbidity of insulin at 650 nm as its disulfide bonds are reduced in the presence of thioredoxin.
  • This example further illustrates the activity of a ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (234) (prepared by methods disclosed in reaction scheme 20) as an inhibitor of the metalloproteinases leucine aminopeptidase M and thermolysin.
  • the method is a modification of that of Spungin-Bialik et al., FEBS Lett. (1996) 380 , 79-82.
  • a second buffer solution, 40 mM in EDTA, is prepared from the first.
  • a 750 ⁇ M solution of substrate, Suc-Ala-Ala-Phe-pNA, is prepared in water from a 50 mM stock solution DMSO.
  • a 15 nM solution of thermolysin is prepared by diluting with buffer a 200 ⁇ M thermolysin stock solution in 20% glycerol/H 2 O.
  • K i values were calculated as before (Example 5).
  • the values of K i obtained for compound (234) were 6 and 11 ⁇ M for thermolysin and leucine aminopeptidase M, respectively.
  • This example further illustrates the activity of a ⁇ -sheet mimetic of structure (235) (prepared by methods disclosed in reaction scheme 15) as an inhibitor of the cysteine proteinase, papain.
  • the assay method is a modification of that of Mellor et al., Biochem. J . (1993) 290, 289 .
  • the assay was conducted in a microtiter plate as in Example 4.
  • a 2 mM stock solution of substrate (Ac-Phe-Gly-pNA) is diluted to 200 ⁇ M in buffer.
  • a 5 mM stock solution (in 50% EtOH/H 2 O) of the inhibitor is diluted to 500 ⁇ M in buffer, and six serial 1:5 dilutions are made. Aliquots of 100 ⁇ L each of buffer, substrate, and inhibitor (at the appropriate concentrations) are added per well to an eight well microtiter strip.
  • a 1.0 mM stock solution of papain is diluted to 200 ⁇ M in buffer and incubated for 5 min prior to addition of a 100 ⁇ L aliquot to the assay wells.
  • the plate should be read 100 ⁇ at 405 nm with 21 second intervals.
  • IC 50 values were calculated as before (Example 4).
  • Compound (234) exhibited an IC 50 value of 8 ⁇ M. This result demonstrates that a ⁇ -sheet mimetic of this invention can function as a cysteine proteinase inhibitor.
  • This example illustrates the activity of ⁇ -sheet mimetics of structures (221-14) and (221-21) of Table 14 as antithrombotic agents.
  • Rats (Splague Dawley) were fasted overnight and used under pentobarbital anesthesia.
  • a polyethylene tube containing a 5 cm silk thread was placed between the right cartid artery and the left junglar vein.
  • Thirty minutes after oral administration of 100 mg.kg of one of the above compounds (dissolved with 50% propylene glycol at 20 mg/ml, and orally administered 5 ml/kg), or one minute after intravenous administration of the Argatroban (0.3 mg/kg) blood was circulated through the tube for seven minutes.
  • the tube was removed and the thrombus wet weight and thrombus protein content were measured. Blood was also withdrawn from the abdominal artery and APTT was measured.

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)
  • Organic Low-Molecular-Weight Compounds And Preparation Thereof (AREA)
  • Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)
  • Nitrogen And Oxygen Or Sulfur-Condensed Heterocyclic Ring Systems (AREA)
  • Indole Compounds (AREA)
  • Preparation Of Compounds By Using Micro-Organisms (AREA)

Abstract

beta -sheet mimetics and methods relating to the same are disclosed. The beta -sheet mimetics have utility as protease and kinase inhibitors, as well as inhibitors of transcription factors and protein-protein binding interactions. Methods of the invention include administration of a beta -sheet mimetic, or use of the same for the manufacture of a medicament for treatment of a variety of conditions associated with the targeted protease, kinase, transcription factor and/or protein-protein binding interaction.

Description

    Technical Field
  • This invention relates generally to (β-sheet mimetics and, more specifically, to (β-sheet mimetics which inhibit biologically active peptides and proteins.
  • Background of the Invention
  • The β-sheet conformation (also referred to as a β-strand conformation) is a secondary structure present in many polypeptides. The β-sheet conformation is nearly fully extended, with axial distances between adjacent amino acids of approximately 3.5 Å. The β-sheet is stabilized by hydrogen bonds between NH and CO groups in different polypeptides strands. Additionally, the dipoles of the peptide bonds alternate along the strands which imparts intrinsic stability to the β-sheet. The adjacent strands in the β-sheet can run in the same direction (i.e., a parallel β-sheet) or in opposite directions (i.e., an antiparallel β-sheet). Although the two forms differ slightly in dihedral angles, both are sterically favorable. The extended conformation of the β-sheet conformation results in the amino acid side chains protruding on alternating faces of the β-sheet.
  • The importance of β-sheets in peptides and proteins is well established (e.g., Richardson, Nature 268:495-499, 1977; Halverson et al., J. Am. Chem Soc. 113:6701-6704, 1991; Zhang, J. Biol. Chem. 266:15591-15596, 1991; Madden et al., Nature 353:321-325, 1991). The β-sheet is important in a number of biological protein-protein recognition events, including interactions between proteases and their substrates, protein kinases and their substrates or inhibitors, the binding of SH2 domain containing proteins to their cognate phosphotyrosine containing protein targets, farnesyl transferase- to its protein substrates, and MHC I and II and their antigenic peptides, and has been implicated in many disease states.
  • Inhibitors that mimic the β-sheet structure of biologically active proteins or peptides would have utility in the treatment of a wide variety of conditions. For example, Ras, the protein product of the ras oncogene, is a membrane bound protein involved in signal transduction regulating cell division and growth. Mutations in the ras gene are among the most common genetic abnormalities associated with human cancers (Barbacid, M. "ras genes," 56:779-827, 1987). These mutations result in a growth signal which is always "on," leading to a cancerous cell. In order to localize to the cell membrane, Ras requires prenylation of the cysteine within its C-terminal CaaX sequence by farnesyl transferase (FTase). (In the sequence CaaX "a" is defined as an amino acid with a hydrophobic side chain and "X" is another amino acid.) This post-translational modification is crucial to its activity. Peptidyl inhibitors of FTase with the sequence CaaX have been shown to block or slow the growth of tumors in cell culture and in whole animals (Kohl et al., "Selective inhibition of ras-dependent transformation by a farnesyltransferase inhibitor," Science 260:1934-1937, 1993; Buss, J.E. & Marsters, Jr., J.C. "Farnesyl transferase inhibitors: the successes and surprises of a new class of potential cancer chemotherapeutics," Chemistry and Biology 2:787-791, 1995).
  • SH2 domains, originally identified in the src subfamily of PTKs, are noncatalytic sequences and consist of about 100 amino acids conserved among a variety of signal transducing proteins (Cohen et al., Cell 80:237-248, 1995). SH2 domains function as phosphotyrosine-binding modules and mediate critical protein-protein associations (Pawson, Nature 573-580, 1995). In particular, the role of SH2 domains has been clearly defined as critical signal transducers for receptor tyrosine kinases (RTKs such as EGF-R, PDGF, insulin receptor, etc.). Phosphotyrosine-containing sites on autophosphorylated RTKs serve as binding sites for SH2-proteins and thereby mediate the activation of biochemical signaling pathways (Carpenter, G., FAESEB J. 6:3283-3289, 1992; Sierke, S. and Koland, J., Biochem. 32:10102-10108, 1993). The SH2 domains are responsible for coupling the activated growth-factor receptors to cellular responses which include alterations in gene expression, cell proliferation, cytoskeletal architecture and metabolism.
  • At least 20 cytosolic proteins have been identified that contain SH2 domains and function in intracellular signaling. The distribution of SH2 domains is not restricted to a particular protein family, but is found in several classes of proteins, protein kinases, lipid kinases, protein phosphatases, phospholipases, Ras-controlling proteins and some transcription factors. Many of the SH2-containing proteins have known enzymatic activities while others (Grb2 and Crk) function as "linkers" and "adapters" between cell surface receptors and downstream effector molecules (Marengere, L., et al., Nature 369:502-505, 1994). Examples of proteins containing SH2 domains with enzymatic activities that are activated in signal transduction include, but are not limited to, the src subfamily of protein tyrosine kinases (src (pp60c-src), abl, lck, fyn, fgr and others), phospholipase-C-γ (PLC-γ), phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase (Pl-3-kinase), p21-ras GTPase activating protein (GAP) and SH2 containing protein tyrosine phosphatases (SH-PTPase) (Songyang et al., Cell 72:767-778, 1993). Intracellular tyrosines are phosphorylated when surface receptors are engaged by diverse ligands for growth factor receptors, cytokine receptors, insulin receptor, and antigen-mediated signaling through T- or B-cell receptors. The phosphorylation of proteins at tyrosine residues is critical in the cellular signal transduction, neoplastic transformation and control of the cell cycle. Due to the central role these various SH2-proteins occupy in transmitting signals from activated cell surface receptors into a cascade of additional molecular interactions that ultimately define cellular responses, inhibitors which block specific SH2-protein binding are desirable as agents for a variety of potential therapeutic applications.
  • Disease areas in which tyrosine phosphorylation and inhibition of SH2 binding represent targets for drug development include the following:
  • Cancer: SH2 domains which mediate signaling are clearly significant elements in the regulation of oncogene and protooncogene tyrosine kinase activity and cellular proliferation (Carpenter, Fed. Am. Soc. Exp. Biol. J. 6:3283-3289, 1992). The SH2 domains define an important set of substrates through which activated RTKs mediate signaling and through which nonreceptor tyrosine kinases associate with RTKs and are thus targets for anticancer drug development. The ability to block interaction of the RTK with the SH2-containing substrate using a mimetic inhibitor provides a means to abrogate signaling and thereby eliminate oncogenic activity. The biological significance is also illustrated by the v-crk oncogene, a protein composed almost entirely of SH domains, which is able to bring about cellular transformation by interacting with phosphotyrosine containing proteins. As above, the ability of inhibitors to block v-crk binding via its SH2 domain to other proteins would be expected to be effective as an anticancer agent.
  • Immune Regulation: Regulation of many immune responses is mediated through receptors that transmit signals through tyrosine kinases containing SH2 domains. T-cell activation via the antigen specific T-cell receptor (TCR) initiates a signal transduction cascade leading to lymphokine secretion and cell proliferation. One of the earliest biochemical responses following TCR activation is an increase in tyrosine kinase activity. In particular, T-cell activation and proliferation is controlled through T-cell receptor mediated activation of p56lck and p59fyn tyrosine kinases, as well as ZAP-70 and Syk (Weiss and Litman, Cell 76:263-274, 1994) which contain SH2 domains. Additional evidence indicates that several src-family kinases (lck blk, fyn) participate in signal transduction pathways leading from B-cell antigen receptors and hence may serve to integrate stimuli received from several independent receptor structures. Thus, inhibitors that block interactions of these SH2 domain kinases with their cognate receptors could serve as immunosuppressive agents with utility in autoimmune diseases, transplant rejection or as anti-inflammatory agents as well as anticancer drugs in cases of lymphocytic leukemias.
  • Additionally, non-transmembrane PTPase containing SH2 domains are known and nomenclature refers to them as SH-PTP1 and SH-PTP2 (Neel, Cell Biology 4:419-432, 1993) SH-PTP1 is identical to PTP1C, HCP or SHP and SH-PTP2 is also known as PTP1D or PTP2C. SH-PTP1 is expressed at high levels in hematopoietic cells of all lineages and all stages of differentiation. Since the SH-PTP1 gene was identified as responsible for the motheaten (me) mouse phenotype, this provides a basis for predicting the effects of inhibitors that would block its interaction with its cellular substates. Thus, inhibition of SH-PTP1 function would be expected to result in impaired T-cell responses to mitogenic stimulation, decreased NK cell function, and depletion of B-cell precursors with potential therapeutic applications as described above.
  • Diabetes: In Type 2 (non-insulin dependent) diabetes, tyrosine phosphatases (SH-PTP2) counter-balance the effect of activated insulin-receptor kinases and may represent important drug targets. In vitro experiments show that injection of PTPase blocks insulin stimulated-phosphorylation of tyrosyl residues on endogenous proteins. Thus, inhibitors could serve to modulate insulin action in diabetes.
  • Neural Regeneration: Glial growth factors are ligands that are specific activators of erb-B2 receptor tyrosine kinase (p185erbB2) to promote tyrosine phosphorylation and mitogenic responses of Schwann cells. Consequently, regulation of tyrosine phosphorylation by altering activity in Schwann cells following nerve injury could be an important therapeutic strategy. Inhibitors of erb-B2 signaling activity could have a significant role in treatment of tumors of glial cell origin.
  • Another class of β-sheet mimetics are inhibitors of protein kinases, which include the protein tyrosine kinases and serine/threonine kinases.
  • A wide variety of cellular substrates for polypeptide growth factor receptors that possess intrinsic tyrosine kinase activity have now been characterized. Although there is a tremendous diversity among the numerous members of the receptors tyrosine-kinases (RTK) family, the signaling mechanisms used by these receptors share many common features. Biochemical and molecular genetic studies have shown that binding of the ligand to the extracellular domain of the RTK rapidly activates the intrinsic tyrosine kinase catalytic activity of the intracellular domain. The increased activity results in tyrosine-specific phosphorylation of a number of intracellular substrates which contain a common sequence motif. Consequently, this causes activation of numerous downstream signaling molecules and a cascade of intracellular pathways that regulate phospholipid metabolism, arachidonate metabolism, protein phosphorylation (involving other protein kinases), calcium mobilization and transcriptional regulation. The growth-factor-dependent tyrosine kinase activity of the RTK cytoplasmic domain is the primary mechanism for generation of intracellular signals that initiate multiple cellular responses. Thus, inhibitors which would serve as alternate substrates or inhibitors of tyrosine kinase activity have the potential to block this signaling.
  • Many of the RTK subfamilies are recognizable on the basis of architectural similarities in the catalytic domain as well as distinctive motifs in the extracellular ligand binding regions. Based upon these structural considerations, a nomenclature defining several subfamilies of RTKs, each containing several members, has been developed (Hanks, Curr. Opin. Struc. Biol. 1:369-383, 1991; Ullrich, A., and Schlessinger, J. Cell 61:203-212, 1990). Examples of receptor subfamilies referred to on the basis of their prototypic members include: EGF-receptor, insulin receptor, platelet-derived growth factor (PDGF-receptor), fibroblast growth factor receptors (FGFRs), TRK receptor and EPH/ECK receptors. Members in each of these subfamilies represent molecular targets for the development of mimetic inhibitors that would block tyrosine kinase activity and prevent intracellular signal transduction. Several therapeutic areas in which these targets have value are identified below.
  • Cancer: In addition to mediating normal cellular growth, members of the EGFR family of RTKs are frequently overexpressed in a variety of aggressive epithelial carcinomas and this is thought to directly contribute to malignant tumor development. A number of studies have shown that the EGFR is frequently amplified in certain types of tumors, including glioblastomas, squamous carcinomas, and brain tumors (Wong et al., Proc. Natl. Acad Sci USA 84:6899-6903, 1987). Additionally, HER2/p185erbB2 (alternatively referred to as "neu" in the rat), HER3/p160erbB3, HER4/p180erbB4 (Plowman, G. et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90:1746-1750 (1993) are three RTKs which have extensive amino acid sequence homology to the EGFR. HER2/p185erbB2 is frequently amplified and overexpressed in human breast tumors and ovarian carcinomas (Wong et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 84:6899-6903, 1987), and this amplification is correlated with poor patient prognosis. Simultaneous overexpression of p185neu and the EGFR synergistically transforms rodent fibroblasts and this condition is often observed in human cancers. Finally, HER3 expression is amplified in a variety of human adenocarcinomas. Several inhibitors are known which demonstrate inhibitory activity in vitro against the EGFR and block EGF-dependent cell proliferation which indicates therapeutic potential of compounds with this activity. In addition, in human chronic myelogenous leukemia, enhanced tyrosine kinase activity underlies the disease as a consequence of activation of the cellular c-abl protooncogene. Inhibitors would function as anticancer agents.
  • Angiogenesis: Currently, there are at least seven FGFR members which mediate a diverse array of biological responses, including the capacity to induce angiogenesis. In addition, a group of RTKs with seven lgLs has been proposed to represent a separate subfamily. Its known members, FLT1, FLK1 and FLT4 show a similarity of structure and expression. These receptors mediate the actions of Vascular Endothelial Growth Factor (VEGF). Several lines of evidence indicate that this subfamily of growth factor receptors play an important role in the formation of blood vessels. Since blood vessel formation is a process reactivated by tumors in order to supply oxygen to these cells, β-strand mimetics that inhibit these growth factors' kinase activities could serve to suppress tumor growth through inhibition of angiogenesis.
  • Restenosis: The PDGF receptor is of great interest as a target for inhibition in the cardiovascular field since it is believed to play a significant role in restenosis after coronary balloon angioplasties and also in atherosclerosis. The release of PDGF by platelets at damaged surfaces of blood vessels results in stimulation of PDGF receptors on vascular smooth muscle cells, and eventual neointimal thickening. A mimetic inhibitor of kinase activity would prevent proliferation and lead to greater successful outcomes from this surgical procedure.
  • Many components of signal transduction pathways involve phosphorylation of serine/threonine (ser/thr) residues of protein substrates. Some of these substrates are themselves protein kinases whose activity is modulated by phosphorylation. Two prominent ser/thr-specific protein kinases play a central role in signal transduction: cyclic AMP-dependent protein kinase A (PKA) and the protein kinase C (PKC family). Numerous other serine/threonine specific kinases, including the family of mitogen-activated protein (MAP) kinases serve as important signal transduction proteins which are activated in either growth-factor receptor or cytokine receptor signaling. Other protein ser/thr kinases important for intracellular signaling are Calcium-dependent protein kinase (CaM-kinase II) and the c-raf-protooncogene.
  • PKC plays a crucial role in cell-surface signal transduction for controlling a variety of physiological processes (Nishizuka, Nature 334:661-665, 1988) and represents a large family of isoenzymes which differ in their structure and expression in different tissues, as well as their substrate specificity (Hug and Sarre, Biochem J. 291:329-343, 1993). Molecular cloning has demonstrated at least 8 isoenzymes. Due to this diversity and differential expression, activation of individual isoenzymes produces differing cell-specific responses: stimulation of growth, inhibition of differentiation, or induction of differentiation. Due to its ability to stimulate cellular proliferation, it represents a target for anticancer drug development (Powis, Trends in Pharm. Sci. 12:188-194, 1991). Overexpression of PKC isoenzymes in mammalian cells is correlated with enhanced expression of early protooncogenes such as c-jun, c-fos, c-myc and one overexpressing cell line gives rise to tumors in nude mice.
  • Therapeutic applications within the area of immune regulation are evident since activation of T-cells by antigens involves activation of PKC. Activated PKC subsequently activates a branch of the signal cascade that is necessary for transcriptional activation of NF-κB, production of IL-2, and ultimately, T-cell proliferation. Inhibitors that block signaling through this branch pathway have been shown to prevent T-cell activation. Thus, mimetics that would function as inhibitors of PKC in T-cells would block signaling and serve as possible immunosuppressants useful in transplant rejection or as anticancer agents for lymphocytic leukemias. Activators of PKC cause edema and inflammation in mouse skin (Hennings et al., Carcinogenesis 8:1342-1346, 1987) and thus inhibitors are also expected to serve as potent anti-inflammatory compounds. Such anti-inflammatory activates would find use in asthma, arthritis and other inflammatory mediated processes. In addition, staurosporine and its analogs, UCN01 and CGP4125, which have been characterized as potent PKC inhibitors in vitro, have anti-tumor activity in animal models (Powis, Trends in Pharm. Sci. 12:188-194, 1991), and related compounds are being considered for clinical trials.
  • With regard to protease inhibition, Cathepsin B is a lysosomal cysteine protease normally involved in proenzyme processing and protein turnover. Elevated levels of activity have been implicated in tumor metastasis (Sloane, B.F. et al., "Cathepsin B and its endogenous inhibitors: the role in tumor malignancy," Cancer Metastasis Rev. 9:333-352, 1990), rheumatoid arthritis (Werb, Z. "Proteinases and matrix degradation," in Textbook of Rheumatology, Keller, W.N.; Harris, W.D.; Ruddy, S.; Sledge, C.S., Eds., 1989, W.B. Saunder Co., Philadelphia, PA, pp. 300-321), and muscular dystrophy (Katunuma N. & Kominami E., "Abnormal expression of lysosomal cysteine proteinases in muscle wasting diseases," Rev. Physiol. Biochem. Pharmacol. 108:1-20, 1987).
  • Calpains are cytosolic or membrane bound Ca++-activated proteases which are responsible for degradation of cytoskeletal proteins in response to changing calcium levels within the cell. They contribute to tissue degradation in arthritis and muscular dystrophy (see Wang K.K. & Yuen P.W., "Calpain inhibition: an overview of its therapeutic potential," Trends Pharmacol. Sci. 15:412-419, 1994).
  • Interleukin Converting Enzyme (ICE) cleaves pro-IL-1 beta to IL-1 beta, a key mediator of inflammation, and therefore inhibitors of ICE may prove useful in the treatment of arthritis (see, e.g., Miller B.E. et al., "Inhibition of mature IL-1 beta production in murine macrophages and a murine model of inflammation by WIN 67694, an inhibitor of IL-1 beta converting enzyme," J. Immunol. 154:1331-1338, 1995). ICE or ICE-like proteases may also function in apoptosis (programmed cell death) and therefore play roles in cancer, AIDS, Alzheimer's disease, and other diseases in which disregulated apoptosis is involved (see Barr, P.J.; Tomei, L.D., "Apoptosis and its Role in Human Disease," Biotechnol. 12:487-493, 1994).
  • HIV protease plays a key role in the life cycle of HIV, the AIDS virus. In the final steps of viral maturation it cleaves polyprotein precursors to the functional enzymes and structural proteins of the virion core. HIV protease inhibitors were quickly identified as an excellent therapeutic target for AIDS (see Huff, J.R., "HIV protease: a novel chemotherapeutic target for AIDS," J. Med. Chem. 34:2305-2314) and have already proven useful in its treatment as evidenced by the recent FDA approval of ritonavir, Crixivan, and saquinavir.
  • Angiotensin converting enzyme (ACE) is part of the renin-angiotensin system which plays a central role in the regulation of blood pressure. ACE cleaves angiotensin I to the octapeptide angiotensin II, a potent pressor agent due to its vasoconstrictor activity. Inhibition of ACE has proved therapeutically useful in the treatment of hypertension (Williams, G.H., "Converting-enzyme inhibitors in the treatment of hypertension," N. Engl. J. Med. 319:1517-1525, 1989.
  • Hepatitis C virus (HCV) is the major cause of non-A and non-B hepatitis in the world today. It is estimated to infect up to 50 million people. Currently there is no satisfactory treatment available to halt the progression of this debilitating disease. During the life cycle of the virus, a polyprotein of about 3000 amino acids is produced and is proteolytically cleaved by host and viral proteases to produce the mature viral gene products. A serine proteinase located within the HCV NS3 protein cleaves at four specific sites to produce non-structural proteins considered essential for viral replication. Hence, inhibitors of HCV protease are attractive targets for drug design, and could be of great therapeutic benefit. (Neddermann et al., Biol. Chem. 378:469-476, 1997.)
  • Collagenases cleave collagen, the major constituent of the extracellular matrix (e.g., connective tissue, skin, blood vessels). Elevated collagenase activity contributes to arthritis (Krane S.M. et al., "Mechanisms of matrix degradation in rheumatoid arthritis," Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 580:340-354, 1990.), tumor metastasis (Plug M. & Kopf-Maier P., "The basement membrane and its involvement in carcinoma cell invasion," Acta Anat. Basel 152:69-84, 1995), and other diseases involving the degradation of connective tissue.
  • Trypsin-like serine proteases form a large and highly selective family of enzymes involved in hemostasis/coagulation (Davie, E.W. and K. Fujikawa, "Basic mechanisms in blood coagulation," Ann. Rev. 799-829, 1975) and complement activation (Muller-Eberhard, H.J., "Complement," Ann. Rev. Biochem. 44:697-724, 1975). Sequencing of these proteases has shown the presence of a homologous trypsin-like core with amino acid insertions that modify specificity and which are generally responsible for interactions with other macromolecular components (Magnusson et al., "Proteolysis and Physiological Regulation," Miami Winter Symposia 11:203-239, 1976).
  • Thrombin, a trypsin-like serine protease, acts to provide limited proteolysis, both in the generation of fibrin from fibrinogen and the activation of the platelet receptor, and thus plays a critical role in thrombosis and hemostasis (Mann, K.G., "The assembly of blood clotting complexes on membranes," Trends Biochem. Sci. 12:229-233, 1987). Thrombin exhibits remarkable specificity in the removal of fibrinopeptides A and B of fibrinogen through the selective cleavage of only two Arg-Gly bonds of the one-hundred and eighty-one Arg- or Lys-Xaa sequences in fibrinogen (Blomback, H., Blood Clotting Enzymology, Seeger, W.H. (ed.), Academic Press, New York, 1967, pp. 143-215).
  • Many significant disease states are related to abnormal hemostasis, including acute coronary syndromes. Aspirin and heparin are widely used in the treatment of patients with acute coronary syndromes. However, these agents have several intrinsic limitations. For example, thrombosis complicating the rupture of atherosclerotic plaque tends to be a thrombin-mediated, platelet-dependent process that is relatively resistant to inhibition by aspirin and heparin (Fuster et al., "The pathogenesis of coronary artery disease and the acute coronary syndromes," N. Engl. J. Med. 326:242-50, 1992).
  • Thrombin inhibitors prevent thrombus formation at sites of vascular injury in vivo. Furthermore, since thrombin is also a potent growth factor which initiates smooth muscle cell proliferation at sites of mechanical injury in the coronary artery, inhibitors block this proliferative smooth muscle cell response and reduce restenosis. Thrombin inhibitors would also reduce the inflammatory response in vascular wall cells (Harker et al., Am. J. Cardiol. 75:12B-16B, 1995).
  • Furthermore, at least two well-defined transcription factors, nuclear factor (NF) κB and activator protein (AP) -1, are regulated by the intracellular reduction-oxidation (redox) state. The regulation of gene expression by the redox state holds promising therapeutic implications. For example, binding sites of the redox-regulated transcription factors NF-κB and AP-1 are located in the promoter region of a large variety of genes that are directly involved in the pathogenesis of diseases, such as AIDS, cancer, atherosclerosis and diabetic complications (Sen and Packer, FASEB Journal 10:709-720, 1996). More specifically, the binding of transcription factors such NF-κB and AP-1 to consensus sites on DNA is driven by oxidant-antioxidant homeostasis, especially by the thiol-disulfide balance.
  • In the case of NF-κB, a physiologically relevant thiol that plays a crucial role in the regulation of NF-κB function is reduced thioredoxin. Thioredoxin is an important protein oxidoreductase with antioxidant functions. Thioredoxin has been found to upregulate DNA binding of activated NF-κB and thus augments gene expression (Schenk et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 91:1672-1676, 1994). Thioredoxin has been implicated in reducing activated cytosolic NF-κB (specifically reduction of cys-62), which may thus contribute to its nuclear translocation and DNA binding (Hayashi et at., J. Biol. Chem. 268:11380-11388, 1993).
  • DNA binding activity of Fos and Jun in the AP-1 complex has also been found to be regulated by the redox state (Abate et al., Science 249:1157-1162, 1990). Each protein contains a single conserved cysteine (flanked by lysine and arginine) in its DNA binding domain. This thiol does not appear to be part of a disulfide bond and may exist as a sulfenic or sulfinic acid in its oxidized form. Ref-1, a bifunctional nuclear protein also possessing endonuclease DNA repair activity, stimulates AP-1 DNA binding by reduction of this regulatory cysteine. A Fos mutant in which the critical cysteine was replaced with serine elicited a three-fold increase in AP-1 DNA binding activity and was no longer subject to redox control (Okuno et al., Oncogene 8:695-701, 1993). Hence, since at least four members of the fos family, 3 of the jun family, and at least 4 of the ATF/CREB family of transcription factors all contain this conserved cysteine, redox control of transcription factors appears widespread.
  • As mentioned above, the regulation of transcription factors such as NF-κB and AP-1 have important therapeutic implications. For example, AP-1 is an important mediator of tumor production (Yoshioka et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 92:4972-4976, 1995). Thus, compounds that repress AP-1 transcriptional activity have utility in the treatment of cancer. Furthermore, due to its direct role in regulating responses to inflammatory cytokines and endotoxins, the activation of NF-κB plays an important role in the development of chronic diseases such as rheumatoid arthritis and acute conditions such as septic shock. Autoimmune diseases, such as systemic lupus erythromatus (SLE), and Alzheimer's disease are also believed involved in activation of NF-κB. Similarly, NF-κB plays an important role in the activation of HIV gene expression. Further conditions which are believed to involve NF-κB include the flu, atherosclerosis, oncogenesis and ataxia telangiectasia (AT).
  • Proteins containing PDZ domains constitute an additional potential target for b-sheet mimetics. These domains of 80-100 amino acid residues mediate protein-protein interactions by binding to a consensus X-Ser/Thr-X-Val sequence at the very carboxyl terminus of proteins. There are also examples of protein interactions via PDZ domains that are internal (or non C-terminal). The crystal structure of liganded and unliganded PDZ domains have been determined and show a six b-strand and two a-helix structure that binds the consensus recognition polypeptide sequence through a b-sheet conformation. Hence, screening of appropriate b-sheet mimetics should prove a valid strategy for targeting PDZ domain-containing proteins. The targets of PDZ domain-containing proteins are varied but important in signal transduction. PSD-95, a membrane associated guanylate kinase contains three PDZ domains, two of which target the Shaker-type K+ channel and the N-methyl-D-aspartate (NMDA) receptor resulting in their clustering that is required for their function. PTPL1/FAP1, a protein tyrosine phosphatase, has five PDZ domains, two of which interact with Fas, a transmembrane protein of the tumor necrosis factor receptor family, that mediates apoptosis in many cell types. Hence, compounds targeting proteins containing the PDZ domains may prove useful as anticancer agents.
  • Tryptase, a trypsin-like serine protease found exclusively in mast cells, has attracted much interest due to its potential role as a mediator of inflammation. For example, in the lung tryptase is released along with other mediators of inflammation in response to binding of an inhaled antigen to cell-surface IgE receptors (Ishizaka and Ishizaka, Prog. Allergy 34:188-235, 1984). Tryptase has also been shown to cleave vasoactive intestinal peptide in vitro (Caughey et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther. 244:133-137, 1988; Tam and Caughey, Am. J. Respir. Cell Mol. Biol. 3:27-32, 1990). These results suggest that tryptase may increase bronchoconstriction via proteolysis of bronchodilating peptides in asthma patients. Consistent with this hypothesis is the recent finding that synthetic tryptase inhibitors blocked airway responses in allergic sheep (Clark et al., Am. J. Respir. Crit. Care Med. 152:2076-2083, 1995).
  • Tryptase activates extracellular matrix-degrading proteins prostromelysin (pro-MMP-3) and procollagenase (pro-MMP-1) via MMP-3, suggesting a role for the enzyme in tissue remodeling and inflammation (Gruber et al., J. Clin. Invest. 84:8154-8158, 1989) and therefore possibly in rheumatoid arthritis. Additionally, prostromelysin, when activated, has been shown to degrade the extracellular matrix around atherosclerotic plaques. Since abnormally high levels of tryptase-containing mast cells have been found in coronary atheromas, tryptase may play a role in atheromatous rupture (release of the thrombus), the final event of coronary atherosclerosis (Kaartinen et al., Circulation 90:1669-1678, 1994).
  • Other activities of tryptase include the following. Tryptase cleaves fibrinogen but is not inactivated in the presence of endogenous proteinase inhibitors (Schwartz et al., J. Immunol. 135:2762-2767, 1985; Ren et al., J. Immunol. 159:3540-3548, 1997), and may function as a local anticoagulant. It has been demonstrated to be a potent mitogen for fibroblasts and may be involved in pulmonary fibrosis and interstitial lung disease (Ruoss et al., J. Clin. Invest. 88:493-499, 1991). Tryptase may also be responsible for the activation of PAR-2 (proteinase activated receptor-2) on endothelial cells and keratinocytes (Molino et al., J. Biol. Chem. 272:4043-4049, 1997).
  • Given the central role of mast cells in allergic and inflammatory responses, inhibition of tryptase may result in significant therapeutic effects. Inhibitors of tryptase may be useful for preventing or treating asthma, pulmonary fibrosis and interstitial pneumonia, nephritis, hepatic fibrosis, hepatitis, hepatic cirrhosis, scleroderma, psoriasis, atopic dermatitis, chronic rheumatoid arthritis, influenza, Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis, inflammatory bowel disease, nasal allergy, and atherosclerosis.
  • Chymase is a chymotrypsin-like protease that is also released from mast cells. It has been demonstrated to cleave angiotensin-I (ang-I) to angiotensin-II (ang-II) with greater efficiency and selectivity than angiotensin-I converting enzyme (ACE) (Okunishi et al., J. Hypertension 2: 227-284, 1984; Urata et al., Circ. Res. 66: 883-890, 1990). In heart tissue chymase has been shown to be a major source of ang-II production from ang-I (Dell'Italia et al., Am. J. Physiol. (Heart Circ. Physiol. 38) 269:H2065-H2073, 1996). In addition, increased chymase activity has been demonstrated in balloon-injury induced hypertrophied vessels in dogs (Shiota et al., FEBS Lett. 323:239-242, 1993). Such evidence suggests that inhibition of chymase may be therapeutic for hypertension, ischaemic heart disease, and congestive heart failure.
  • Urokinase-type plasminogen activator (uPA) is a trypsin-like serine proteinase which converts plasminogen to plasmin as part of the fibrinolytic system. It has long been used for thrombolysis in acute massive pulmonary embolism. Other research has shown that uPA is also a key initiator of the extra-cellular proteolytic cascade involved in cellular invasiveness (Mullins and Rohlich, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 695: 177-214, 1983; Testa and Quigly, Cancer Metast. Rev. 9:353-367, 1990). In addition uPA binds to uPA receptor (uPAR) through its growth factor domain and further modulates the activity of other proteins involved in cell migration. Overexpression of uPA appears to play a part in cancer invasiveness and metastasis; high levels of uPA, PAI-1 (plasminogen activator inhibitor-1), and uPAR correlate with poor patient prognosis. A variety of research in various model systems demonstrates that inhibitors of uPA decrease tumor cell invasiveness and metastasis (Testa and Quigly, ibid; Andreasen et al., Int J Cancer 72:1-22, 1997). Hence, inhibition of uPA may be useful in the treatment of breast cancer, prostate cancer, ovarian cancer, human renal cell cancer, gastric cancer, and lung cancer. Recent evidence indicates that inhibitors of uPA may also be useful in the prevention of restenosis (Loskutoff, Circulation 96:2772-2774, 1997).
  • In view of the important biological role played by the β-sheet, there is a need in the art for compounds which can stabilize the intrinsic β-sheet structure of a naturally occurring or synthetic peptide, protein or molecule. There is also a need in the art for making stable β-sheet structures, as well as the use of such stabilized structures to effect or modify biological recognition events which involve β-sheet structures. The present invention fulfills these needs and provides further related advantages.
  • Summary of the Invention
  • Briefly stated, the present invention is directed to β-sheet mimetics and the use thereof, including use for the manufacture of a medicament for achieving therapeutic effects in a warm-blooded animal through one or more of protease inhibition, kinase inhibition, regulation of a transcription factor and/or by inhibiting protein-protein binding interactions. The therapeutic effects result from administering to the warm-blooded animal a therapeutically effective amount of a β-sheet mimetic having the general structure as set forth in claim 1. Such a structure includes a bicyclic ring system, of general structure (I) (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof) :
    Figure 00220001
       wherein
  • A is selected from -C(=O)-(CH2)0-4-, -C(=O)(CH2)1-3-, -(CH2)1-2O- and -(CH2)1-2S-;
  • B is selected from N and CH;
  • C is selected from -C(=O) (CH2)1-3-, -(CH2)0-3-, -O-(CH2)1-2- and -S(CH2)1-2-;
  • D is selected from N and C(R4);
  • E is selected from
    Figure 00230001
    and
    Figure 00230002
  • F is an optional carbonyl moiety;
  • R1, R3 and R4 are independently selected from amino acid side chain moieties and derivatives thereof;
  • R2 and R2' represent one or more ring substituents individually selected from an amino acid side chain moiety and derivatives thereof, or R2 taken together with C or Y forms a fused substituted or unsubstituted homocyclic or heteocyclic ring;
  • Y and Z represent the remainder of the molecule; and
  • any two adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring may form a double bond.
  • In one embodiment where F (i.e., the optional carbonyl moiety) is present and E is -N(Z)-, the bicyclic ring system include the following structure (II):
    Figure 00230003
    wherein A, B, C, D, R2, R2', R3, Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I).
  • In a preferred aspect of this embodiment, A is either. -C(=O)- or -(CH2)- and C is -(CH2)2-, as represented by the following structures (IIa) and (IIb):
    Figure 00240001
    In this embodiment, the six-member ring may be saturated or unsaturated (including aromatic). For example, when B and D of structures (IIa) and (IIb) are both -CH- (and thus constitute adjacent CH groups that may form a double bond), the bicyclic ring system include the following aromatic structures (IIc) and (IId):
    Figure 00240002
    Similarly, the following unsaturated compounds having structures (IIe) and (IIf) are also representative of the bicyclic ring system of structures (IIa) and (IIb) :
    Figure 00240003
  • In another embodiment where F is present and E is -C(R1) (NHZ)-, the bicyclic ring system include the following structure (III):
    Figure 00250001
    wherein A, B, C, D, R1, R2, R2', R3, Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I).
  • In a preferred aspect of this embodiment, A is either -C(=O)- or -(CH2)- and C is -(CH2)2-, as represented by the following structures (IIIa) and (IIIb):
    Figure 00250002
    In this embodiment, the six-member ring may be saturated or unsaturated (including aromatic). For example, when B and D of structures (IIIa) and (IIIb) are both -CH- (and thus constitute adjacent CH groups that may form a double bond), the bicyclic ring system include the following aromatic structures (IIIc) and (IIId):
    Figure 00260001
    Similarly, the following unsaturated compounds having structures (IIIe) and (IIIf) are also representative of the bicyclic ring system of structures (IIIa) and (IIIb):
    Figure 00260002
  • In a further embodiment when F is present and E is -C(R1)(Z)-, the bicyclic ring system include the following structure (IV):
    Figure 00260003
    wherein A, B, C, D, R1, R2, R2', R3, Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I), and with the proviso that Z does not contain an -NH- moiety attached to the carbon atom having the R1 substituent (and thus distinct from the bicyclic ring system of structure (III) above).
  • In a preferred aspect of this embodiment, A is either -(C=O)- or -(CH2)- and C is -(CH2)2-, as represented by the following structures (IVa) and (IVb):
    Figure 00270001
  • In this embodiment, the six-member ring may be saturated or unsaturated (including aromatic). For example, when B and D of structures (IVa) and (IVb) are both -CH- (and thus constitute adjacent CH groups that may form a double bond), the bicyclic ring system include the following aromatic structures (IVc) and (IVd):
    Figure 00270002
    Similarly, the following unsaturated compounds having structures (IVe) and (IVf) are also representative of the bicyclic ring system of structures (IVa) and (IVb):
    Figure 00280001
  • In a further embodiment where F is not present and E is either -N(Z)-, -C(R1)(NHZ)- or -C(R1)(Z)-, the bicyclic ring system include the following structures (V), (VI) and (VII):
    Figure 00280002
    wherein A, B, C, D, R1, R2, R2', R3, Y and Z are as defined above with regard to structure (I).
  • The compounds according to the invention have a structure including: the bicyclic ring system shown above. In an embodiment where F is present, and R2 taken together with C forms a substituted or unsubstituted, homocyclic or heterocyclic fused ring compounds of this inventions include those of the following structures (IX) and (X):
    Figure 00290001
    wherein A, B, C, D, E, R2, R2', R3 and Y are as defined above, and R' is one or more optional ring substituents.
  • In one aspect of structure (IX), R2 and C taken together form a fused five-, six-, seven- or eight-membered ring as represented by structures (IXa) and (IXb):
    Figure 00300001
    wherein A, B, D, E, R2, R2', R3, R' and Y are as defined above.
  • In one aspect of structure (X), R2 and C taken together form a fused five-, six-, seven- or eight-. membered ring as represented by structures (Xa) and (Xb):
    Figure 00300002
    wherein A, B, C, D, E, Y, R2, R2', R3 and R' are as defined above, and X is selected from -C(=O)-, -NH-, -NR'-, -O-and -S-.
  • In a further embodiment where F is present, and R2 taken together with Y forms a substituted or unsubstituted, homocyclic or heterocyclic fused ring compounds of this invention include those of the following structure (XI):
    Figure 00310001
    wherein A, B, C, D, E, R2, R2' and R3 are as defined above.
  • In one aspect of this embodiment, R2 and Y taken together form a fused five-, six-, seven- or eight-membered ring as represented by structures (XIa) and (XIb):
    Figure 00310002
    wherein A, B, C, D, E, R2, R2' and R' are as defined above, R' is an optional substituent, and X is selected from -NH-, -NR'-, -O- and -S-.
  • These and other aspects of this invention will become apparent upon reference to the following detailed description.
  • Brief Description of the Drawings
  • Figure 1 is a plot showing the effect of various concentrations of structure (20b) on platelet deposition in a vascular graft.
  • Figure 2 is a plot showing the effect of various concentrations of structure (39) on platelet deposition in a vascular graft.
  • Figure 3 is a plot showing the effect of various concentrations of structure (29b) on platelet deposition in a vascular graft.
  • Figures 4A and 4B illustrate the bioavailability of structure (20b) via both IV and PO administration.
  • Figures 5A and 5B illustrate the ability of structures (221-5) and (221-6) to serve as antithrombotic agents.
  • Detailed Description of the Invention
  • As mentioned above, the (β-sheet is an important structural component for many biological recognition events. The β-sheet mimetics of this invention serve to impart and/or stabilize the β-sheet structure of a natural or synthetic peptide, protein or molecule, particularly with regard to conformational stability. In addition, the β-sheet mimetics of this invention are more resistant to proteolytic breakdown, thus rendering a peptide, protein or molecule containing the same more resistant to degradation. The β-sheet mimetic may be positioned at either the C-terminus or N-terminus of the protein, peptide or molecule, or it may be located within the protein, peptide or molecule itself, and more than one β-sheet mimetic of the present invention may be incorporated in a protein, peptide or molecule.
  • The β-sheet mimetics of this invention include the bicyclic ring system generally represented by structure (I) above as well as the more specific structures (II) through (VII) and are represented by structures (IX) through (XI). The β-sheet mimetics of this invention may be constructed to mimic the three-dimensional conformation of a β-sheet comprised of naturally occurring L-amino acids, as well as the structure of a β-sheet comprised of one or more D-amino acids. Thus, all stereoconformations of the bicyclic ring system of structure (I) are included within the compounds of this invention.
  • For example, the bicyclic ring system of structure (II) includes the following structures (II') and (II"):
    Figure 00330001
    Similarly, the bicyclic ring system of structure (III) includes the following structures (III') through (III""):
    Figure 00340001
    Figure 00340002
  • The bicyclic ring system of structure (IV) includes these same stereoconfirmations, but with the "Z-NH" moiety of structures (III') through (III'''') replaced with a "Z" moiety.
  • As used herein, the term "an amino acid side chain moiety" as used to define the R1, R2, R2', R3, and R4 moieties represents any amino acid side chain moiety present in naturally occurring proteins, including (but not limited to) the naturally occurring amino acid side chain moieties identified in Table 1 below. Other naturally occurring side chain moieties of this invention include (but are not limited to) the side chain moieties of phenylglycine, 3,5-dibromotyrosine, 3,5-diiodotyrosine, hydroxylysine, naphthylalanine, thienylalanine, γ-carboxyglutamate, phosphotyrosine, phosphoserine and glycosylated amino acids such as glycosylated serine, asparagine and threonine.
    Figure 00350001
  • In addition to naturally occurring amino acid side chain moieties, the amino acid side chain moieties of the present invention also include various derivatives thereof. As used herein, a "derivative" of an amino acid side chain moiety includes all modifications and/or variations to naturally occurring amino acid side chain moieties. For example, the amino acid side chain moieties of alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, phenylglycine and phenylalanine may generally be classified as lower chain alkyl, aryl or aralkyl moieties. Derivatives of amino acid side chain moieties include other straight chain or branched, cyclic or noncyclic, substituted or unsubstituted, saturated or unsaturated lower chain alkyl, aryl or aralkyl moieties.
  • As used herein, "lower chain alkyl moieties" contain from 1-12 carbon atoms, "lower chain aryl moieties" contain from 6-12 carbon atoms, and "lower chain aralkyl moieties" contain from 7-12 carbon atoms. Thus, in one embodiment, the amino acid side chain derivative is selected from a C1-12 alkyl, a C6-12 aryl and a C7-12 aralkyl, and in a more preferred embodiment, from a C1-7 alkyl, a C6-10 aryl and a C7-11 aralkyl.
  • Amino acid side chain derivatives of this invention further include substituted derivatives of lower chain alkyl, aryl and aralkyl moieties, wherein the substituent is selected from (but are not limited to) one or more of the following chemical moieties: -OH, -OR, - COOH, -COOR, -CONH2, -NH2, -NHR, -NRR, -SH, -SR, -SO2R, -SO2H, -SOR and halogen (including F, Cl, Br and I), wherein each occurrence of R is independently selected from a lower chain alkyl, aryl or aralkyl moiety. Moreover, cyclic lower chain alkyl, aryl and aralkyl moieties of this invention include naphthalene, as well as heterocyclic compounds such as thiophene, pyrrole, furan, imidazole, oxazole, thiazole, pyrazole, 3-pyrroline, pyrrolidine, pyridine, pyrimidine, purine, quinoline, isoquinoline and carbazole. Amino acid side chain derivatives further include heteroalkyl derivatives of the alkyl portion of the lower chain alkyl and aralkyl moieties, including (but not limited to) alkyl and aralkyl phosphonates and silanes.
  • As used in the context of this invention, the term "remainder of the molecule" (as represented by Y and Z) may be any chemical moiety, including (but not limited to) amino acid side chain moieties and derivatives thereof as defined above. For example, when the β-sheet mimetic is located within the length of a peptide or protein, Y and Z may represent amino acids of the peptide or protein. Alternatively, if two or more β-sheet mimetics are linked, the Y moiety of a first β-sheet mimetic may represent a second β-sheet mimetic while, conversely, the Z moiety of the second β-sheet mimetic represents the first β-sheet mimetic.
  • When the β-sheet mimetic is located at the end of a peptide or protein, or when the β-sheet mimetic is not associated with a peptide or protein, Y and/or Z may represent a suitable terminating moiety. For example, representative terminating moieties for the Z moiety include (but are not limited to) -H, -OH, -R, -C(=O)R and -SO2R (where R is selected from a lower chain alkyl moiety, a lower chain aryl moiety and a lower chain aralkyl moiety), or may be a suitable protecting group for protein synthesis, such as BOC, FMOC and CBZ (i.e., tert-butyloxycarbonyl, 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl and benzyloxycarbonyl, respectively).
  • Similarly, representative terminating moieties for the Y moiety include (but are not limited to) -H, -OH, -R, -SO2R, -SOR, -SO2NHR, -CF3, -C2F5, -NHOH, -NHNHR, -C(=O)H, -C(=O)R, -C(=O)CF3, -C(=O)OR, -C(=O)CH2OR, -C(=O)NHR, -CH2X', -C(=O)CH2X', -C(=O)C(=O)NRR, -C(=O)CHN2,
    Figure 00380001
    Figure 00380002
    Figure 00380003
    -C(=O)CH=CHC(=O)OH, -C(=O)CH=CHC(=O)R, -C(=O)CH=CHC(=O)OR, -C(=O)CH=CHC(=O)NRR, -CH(OH)CH=CHC(=O)OH, -CH(OH)CH=CHC(=O)R, -CH(OH)CH=CHC(=O)OR, -CH(OH)CH=CHC(=O)NRR, -CH=CHSO2R and -SO2CH=CHR (where X' is Cl, F, Br or I, and each occurrence of R is independently selected from a lower chain alkyl moiety, a lower chain aryl moiety and a lower chain aralkyl moiety), or a heterocyclic moiety, such as pyridine, pyran, thiophan, pyrrole, furan, thiophene, thiazole, benzthiazole, oxazole, benzoxazole, imidazole and benzimidazole.
  • More specifically, suitable Z and Y terminating moieties of this invention include the following groups:
    Z Moieties Y Moieties
    R6-X- -X-R6
    R7-X- -X-R7
    (R8)2N-X- -X-N(R8)2
    R9-O-X- -X-O-R9
    R10-S(O)p-X- -X-S(O)pR10
       wherein
  • X is optionally present and selected from a straight chain or branched, cyclic or noncyclic, saturated or nonsaturated C1-12 alkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, =O, OR, ONRR, C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, OC(O)R, C(O)NRR, C(O)NROR, NH2, NO2, NHOR, C(NR), NHR, C(O)NRR, NHC(NR)NHR, P(OR)3 and SiRRR;
  • R6 is selected from H, CN, NO2 SiRRR and P(OR)3;
  • R7 is selected from C5-14 aryl, C4-13 heteroaryl, C3-14 cycloalkyl, C5-14 cycloalkylene, and C2-13 heterocycloalkyl, each of which may be optionally substituted with one or more substituents selected from X, halogen, OR, ONRR, C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, OC(O)R, NR2, C(O)NRR, C(O)NROR, NRC(O)R, C(NR)NHR, NHC(NR)NHR, NO2 SO2R, SO2NRR, SiRRR, OP(OR)3, CH2P(OR)3 and CF2P(OR)3;
  • R8 is, at each occurrence, independently selected from H, X, R7, halogen, OR, =C=O, C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, OC(O)R, NR2, C(O)NRR, NRC(O)R, C(NR)NHR, NO2, SO2R, SO2NRR, SiRRR and P(OR)3, or, taken together, may form a saturated or unsaturated C2-14 cycloalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents selected from =O, X, R7, halogen, OR, =C=O, C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, OC(O)R, NR2, C(O)NRR, NRC(O)R, C(NR)NHR, NO2 SO2R, SO2NRR, SiRRR and P(OR)3;
  • R9 is selected from H, X, R7, halogen C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, NR2 C(O)NRR, NRC(O)R, C(NR)NHR, NO2, SO2R, SO2NRR, SiRRR and P(OR)3, where p = 0-2;
  • R10 is selected from H, X, R7, halogen, OR, C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, NR2 and C(O)NRR; and
  • each occurrence of R in the above definitions of R6 through R10 is independently selected from H, C1-6 alkyl, C3-14 cycloalkyl, C5-14 cycloalkylene, C6-14 aryl, C4-13 heteroaryl and C2-13 heterocycloalkyl, or, when two R groups are present, taken together form a saturated or unsaturated C2-8 cycloalkyl.
  • In the context of protease inhibitors, the Y terminating moiety further includes the following group: -N({C(R11)2C(O) -Tm}n-Wk-R12)2    wherein
  • m = 0-1;
  • n = 0-20;
  • k = 0-1;
  • R11 is, at each occurrence, independently selected from an amino acid side chain moiety and derivative thereof;
  • T is, at each occurrence, independently selected from C=O, C(O)-N(R12) and N(R12);
  • W is, at each occurrence, independently selected from a C2-14 heterocycle; and
  • R12 is, at each occurrence, independently selected from H, X, X-R6, X-R7, X-NCR8)2, X-O-R9, X-S(O)pR10 and P(OR)3, or, taken together, may form a saturated or unsaturated C2-14 cycloalkyl optionally substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, =O, OR, ONRR, C(O)R, C(O)OR, CN, OC(O)R, C(O)NRR, C(O)NROR, NH2, NO2, NHOR, C(NR)NHR, NHC(NR)NHR, P(OR)3 and SiRRR; and
  • R, R6, R7, R8, R9, R10, X and p are as defined immediately above;
  • with the proviso that when n=0 each of R12 are not both hydrogen.
  • In the context of the bicyclic ring system structure (I) above, any two adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring may form a double bond. Such double bonds may be present in isolation or conjugation with one or more additional double bonds, including aromatic ring systems. For example, representative isolated double bonds includes the bicyclic ring system of structures (IIe), (IIf), (IIIe), (IIIf), (IVe) and (IVf) above. Representative aromatic bicyclic ring systems resulting from conjugated double bonds are depicted by structures (IIc), (IId), (IIIc), (IIId), (IVc) and (IVd) above.
  • Within a specific embodiment, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having structure (II) above, wherein A is -C(=O)-, B is N, C is -(CH2)2- or -C(=O)CH2-, D is N, and the optional carbonyl moiety F is present, as represented by the following structures (IIg), (IIh) and (IIh'):
    Figure 00410001
    Similarly, when B and D are both CH, representative bicyclic ring system include the following structures (IIi), (IIj) and (IIj'):
    Figure 00420001
  • Within another specific embodiment bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having structure (III) above. In one aspect of this embodiment, D is N and the bicyclic ring system has the following structure (IIIi):
    Figure 00420002
    wherein A is selected from -C(=O)-, -(CH2)0-4- and -C(=O)(CH2)1-3-; B is selected from N and CH; C is selected from -C(=O)- and -(CH2)0-3-; and the bicyclic ring system is saturated (i.e., contains no double bonds between adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring system).
  • In this embodiment where B is CH and R3 is hydrogen, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structures (IIIj), (IIIk) and (IIIl):
    Figure 00430001
  • In an embodiment of structure (IIIi) where B is N and R3 is hydrogen, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structures (IIIm), (IIIn) and (IIIo):
    Figure 00430002
  • In preferred embodiments, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structures (IIIp), (IIIq), (IIIr) and (IIIr'):
    Figure 00430003
  • In another embodiment of structure (IIIi) above, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structure (IIIs):
    Figure 00440001
    wherein A is selected from -(CH2)0-4-, -(CH2)1-2O- and -(CH2)1-2S-; C is selected from -(CH2)0-3-, -O-, -S-, -O(CH2)1-2- and -S(CH2)1-2-; and the bicyclic ring system is saturated.
  • In an embodiment of structure (IIIs) where A is - (CH2)0-4-, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structure (IIIf):
    Figure 00440002
  • In an embodiment of structure (IIIs) where A is -(CH2)1-2O- or -(CH2)1-2S-, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structures (IIIu) and (IIIv) :
    Figure 00440003
  • In an embodiment of structure (IIIs) where C is -(CH2)1-3-, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structure (IIIw):
    Figure 00440004
       where A is selected from -(CH2)1-4-, -(CH2)1-2O- and -(CH2)1-2S-.
  • In an embodiment of structure (IIIs) where C is -O- or -S-, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structures (IIIx) and (IIIy):
    Figure 00450001
  • In an embodiment of structure (Ills) where C is -O(CH2)1-2- or -S (CH2)1-2-, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having the following structures (IIIz) and (IIIza):
    Figure 00450002
  • Within a further embodiment, bicyclic ring systems are disclosed having strucutre (IV) above. In one aspect of this embodiment, A is -C(=O)-, B is CH or N, C is -(CH2)2- or -C(=O)CH2-, D is N and the optional carbonyl moiety is present, as represented by the following structures (IVg), (IVg'), (IVh) and (IVh'):
    Figure 00450003
  • In embodiments where F is not present, bicyclic ring systems having structures (V), (VI) and (VII) are disclosed. With respect to bicyclic ring systems of structure (V), when A is -C(=O)-, B and D are both CH or N, and C is -(CH2)2-, representative bicyclic ring systems of this invention include the following structures (Va), (Vb) and (Vc):
    Figure 00460001
    Figure 00460002
  • Similarly, in structure (VI), when A is -C(=O)-, B and D are both CH or N, and C is -(CH2)2-, representative bicyclic ring systems include the following structures (VIa), (VIb) and (VIc):
    Figure 00460003
    Figure 00470001
  • As for structure (VII), when A is -C(=O)-, B and D are both CH or N, and C is -(CH2)2-, representative bicyclic ring systems include the following structures (VIIa), (VIIb) and (VIIc) :
    Figure 00470002
    Figure 00470003
  • In an embodiment of structure (IX), wherein A is -C(=O)-, B and D are both N, E is -N(Z)-, -C(R1)(NHZ)- or -C(R2)(Z)-, and F is present, compounds of this invention include structures (IXc) through (IXh).
    Figure 00480001
    Figure 00490001
  • In an embodiment of structure (X), where A is -C(=O)-, B is N, D is N and E is Z-N, compounds of this invention include structures (Xc) and (Xd):
    Figure 00490002
  • In an embodiment of structure (XI), where A is -C(=O)-, B is N, C is -CH2C(=0)-, D is N and E is Z-N, compounds of this invention include structure (XIc) :
    Figure 00490003
  • The bicyclic ring systems may be synthesized by one skilled in the art by known organic synthesis techniques. For example, the various embodiments of structure (I) may be synthesized according to the following reaction schemes.
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (III) can be synthesized by the following reaction schemes (where n = 0-4, p = 0-3 and m = 0-2):
  • Reaction Scheme (1)
  • Figure 00500001
    Figure 00510001
  • Reaction Scheme (2)
  • Structure (IIIk) can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00520001
  • Reaction Scheme (3)
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIl) having structure (IIIl') can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme, where structure (IIIl") in scheme (3) is a representative structure of the invention having a double bond in the bicyclic ring system:
    Figure 00530001
  • In addition, representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIl) having structure (IIIl" ') may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme, and when A of structure (IIIl) is -C(=O) (CH2)1-3-, a related bicyclic ring system (designated (IIIi') below) can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00540001
  • Reaction Scheme (4)
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIm) having structures (IIIm') and (IIIm") below, wherein R3 is hydrogen, can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme (see Holmes and Neel, Tet. Lett. 31:5567-70, 1990):
    Figure 00550001
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIi)
    wherein R3 is an amino acid side chain moiety or derivative thereof may also be prepared according to the above scheme (4).
  • Reaction Scheme (5)
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIn) having structure (IIIn') can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00560001
  • Reaction Scheme (6)
  • Structure (IIIo) can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00570001
  • Reaction Scheme (7)
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIp) having structures (IIIp') and (IIIp") shown below, can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00580001
  • Reaction Scheme (8)
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIIq) having structures (IIIq') and (IIIq") can be synthesized by the following reaction scheme (see Jungheim & Sigmund, J. Org. Chem. 52:4007-4013, 1987) :
    Figure 00590001
  • Reaction Scheme (9)
  • Structure (IIIr) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme (see Perkin, J. Chem. Soc. Perk. Trans. 1:155-164, 1984):
    Figure 00590002
  • Reaction Scheme (10)
  • Structure (IIIt) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00600001
  • Reaction Scheme (11)
  • Structures (IIIu) and (IIIv) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00610001
  • Reaction Scheme (12)
  • Structure (IIIw) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00620001
  • Reaction Scheme (13)
  • Structures (IIIx) and (IIIy) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00630001
    Figure 00640001
  • 0Reaction Scheme (14)
  • Structures (IIIz) and (IIIza) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 00650001
    Figure 00660001
    Figure 00660002
  • According to the definition of structure (I) above, the bicyclic ring system may contain adjacent CH groups (i.e., the bicyclic ring system may be formed, at least in part, by a -CH-CH- group). Bicyclic ring systems wherein such a -CH-CH- group is replaced with a -C=C- are also included within the scope of structure (I) (i.e., any two adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring may together form a double bond).
  • Reaction Schemes (15), (16) and (17) illustrate further synthetic methodology for preparing representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (III).
  • Reaction Scheme (15)
  • Figure 00670001
  • Reaction Scheme (16)
  • Figure 00670002
  • Reaction Scheme (17)
  • Figure 00680001
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IV) may be prepared by the following reaction schemes (18) through (21).
  • Reaction Scheme (18)
  • Figure 00680002
  • Reaction Scheme (19)
  • Starting material by method of Miller and Watkins, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 90:1515, 1976.
    Figure 00690001
  • Alternatively, structures (IVc) and (IVd) may be made by reaction scheme (19-1).
  • Reaction Scheme (19-1)
  • Figure 00700001
  • Reaction Scheme (20)
  • Figure 00710001
  • Reaction Scheme (21)
  • Figure 00720001
  • Alternatively, structure (IVf) may be made by the following reaction scheme (21-1).
  • Reaction Scheme (21-1)
  • Figure 00730001
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (II) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme (24):
  • Reaction Scheme (24)
  • Figure 00750001
  • Further representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (II) may be made by the following reaction scheme (25) :
  • Reaction Scheme (25) :
  • Figure 00760001
  • Further representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (III) may be made by the following reaction scheme (26):
  • Reaction Scheme (26):
  • Figure 00770001
  • Bicyclic ring systems of structures (V), (VI) and (VII) may be made by the same general techniques as disclosed above for compounds of structures (II), (III) and (IV), with the exception that the respective precursor intermediate does not contain a carbonyl moiety at position F.
  • Further, compounds according to this invention of structure (IX) may be prepared according to reaction scheme (27):
  • Reaction Scheme (27)
  • Figure 00780001
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIe) may be made by the following reaction scheme (28) :
  • Reaction Scheme (28)
  • Figure 00790001
  • Representative compounds of this invention of structure (X) may be made by the following reaction scheme (29):
  • Reaction Scheme (29)
  • Figure 00800001
  • Representative compounds of structure (XIc) may be made by the following reaction scheme (30):
  • Reaction Scheme (30)
  • Figure 00800002
  • Representative compounds of structure (XId) may be made by the following reaction scheme (31):
  • Reaction Scheme (31):
  • Figure 00810001
  • Representative bicyclic ring systems of structure (IIh') may be made by the following reaction schemes (32) and (33):
  • Reaction Scheme (32) :
  • Figure 00820001
  • Reaction Scheme (33);
  • Figure 00830001
  • In one embodiment of β-sheet mimetics of this invention, Y groups have the structure:
    Figure 00830002
    where a preferred stereochemistry is:
    Figure 00830003
  • Preferred R4 groups are organoamine moieties having from about 2 to about 10 carbon atoms and at least one nitrogen atom. Suitable organoamine moieties have the chemical formula C2-10H4-20N1-6O0-2; and preferably have the chemical formula C3-7H7-14N1-4O0-1. Exemplary organoamine moieties of the invention are (wherein R is selected from hydrogen, halogen (e.g., fluorine), lower chain alkyl (e.g., methyl), and hydroxy lower chain alkyl (e.g., hydroxymethyl); and X is selected from CH2, NH, S and O):
    Figure 00840001
    Figure 00840002
  • In the above structure, R5 is selected from (a) alkyl of 1 to about 12 carbon atoms, optionally substituted with 1-4 of halide, C1-5alkoxy and nitro, (b) -C(=O)NH-C1-5alkyl, wherein the alkyl group is optionally substituted with halide or C1-5alkoxy, (c) -C(=O)NH-C1- 10aralkyl where the aryl group may be optionally substituted with up to five groups independently selected from nitro, halide, -NH- (C=O) C1-5alkyl, -NH-(C=O)C6-10aryl, C1-5alkyl and C1-5alkoxy, and (d) monocyclic and bicyclic heteroaryl of 4 to about 11 ring atoms, where the ring atoms are selected from carbon and the heteroatoms oxygen, nitrogen and sulfur, and where the heteroaryl ring may be optionally substituted with up to about 4 of halide, C1-5alkyl, C1-5alkoxy, -C(=O)NHC1-5alkyl, -C(=O)NHC6-10aryl, amino, -C(=O)OC1-5alkyl and -C(=O)OC6-10aryl.
  • Preferred R5 groups are:
    Figure 00850001
    wherein R6 is hydrogen, nitro, halide, NH-C(=O)-C1-5alkyl, NH-C(=O)-C6-10aryl, C1-C5alkyl and C1-C5 alkoxy;
    Figure 00850002
    wherein X is halide;
    Figure 00850003
    wherein E is -O-, -NH- or -S- and R7 and R8 are independently selected from hydrogen, C1-5alkyl, -C(=O)OC1-5alkyl, -C(=O)OC6-10aryl, -C(=O)NHC1-5alkyl and -C(=O)NHC6-10aryl; and
    Figure 00850004
    wherein E and R6 are as defined previously.
  • The β-sheet mimetics of the present invention may be used in standard peptide synthesis protocols, including automated solid phase peptide synthesis. Peptide synthesis is a stepwise process where a peptide is formed by elongation of the peptide chain through the stepwise addition of single amino acids. Amino acids are linked to the peptide chain through the formation of a peptide (amide) bond. The peptide link is formed by coupling the amino group of the peptide to the carboxylic acid group of the amino acid. The peptide is thus synthesized from the carboxyl terminus to the amino terminus. The individual steps of amino acid addition are repeated until a peptide (or protein) of desired length and amino acid sequence is synthesized.
  • To accomplish peptide (or protein or molecule) synthesis as described above, the amino group of the amino acid to be added to the peptide should not interfere with peptide bond formation between the amino acid and the peptide (i.e., the coupling of the amino acid's carboxyl group to the amino group of the peptide). To prevent such interference, the amino groups of the amino acids used in peptide synthesis are protected with suitable protecting groups. Typical amino protecting groups include, for example, BOC and FMOC groups. Accordingly, in one embodiment of the present invention, the β-sheet mimetics of the present invention bear a free carboxylic acid group and a protected amino group, and are thus suitable for incorporation into a peptide by standard synthetic techniques.
  • The β-sheet mimetics of this invention may be synthesized on solid support, typically via a suitable linker. The β-sheet mimetics may then be cleaved from the solid support by, for example, aminolysis, and screened as competitive substrates against appropriate agents, such as the chromogenic substrate BAPNA (benzyoylarginine paranitroanalide)(see Eichler and Houghten, Biochemistry 32:11035-11041, 1993)(incorporated herein by reference). Alternatively, by employing a suitable linker moiety, such screening may be performed while the β-sheet mimetics are still attached to the solid support.
  • Once a substrate is selected by the above kinetic analysis, the β-sheet mimetic may be converted into an inhibitor by modifications to the C-terminal-that is, by modification to the Y moiety. For example, the terminal Y moiety may be replaced with -CH2Cl, -CF3,-H, or -C(O)NHR. Appropriate R moieties may be selected using a library of substrates, or using a library of inhibitors generated using a modification of the procedure of Wasserman and Ho (J. Org. Chem. 59:4364-4366, 1994) (incorporated herein by reference).
  • Libraries of compounds containing β-strand templates may be constructed to determine the optimal sequence for substrate recognition or binding. Representative strategies to use such libraries are discussed below.
  • A representative β-sheet mimetic substrate library may be constructed as follows. It should be understood that the following is exemplary of methodology that may be used to prepare a β-sheet mimetic substrate library, and that other libraries may be prepared in an analogous manner.
  • In a first step, a library of the following type:
    Figure 00870001
  • R1, R3, R =
    amino acid side chain moieities or derivatives thereof; Y = H, Ac, SO2R; and the circled "P" represents a solid support.
    may be constructed on a solid support (PEGA resin, Meldal, M. Tetrahedron Lett. 33:3077-80, 1992; controlled pore glass, Singh et al., J. Med. Chem. 38:217-19, 1995). The solid support may then be placed in a dialysis bag (Bednarski et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc. 109:1283-5, 1987) with the enzyme (e.g., a protease) in an appropriate buffer. The bag is then placed in a beaker with bulk buffer. The enzymatic reaction is monitored as a function of time by HPLC and materials cleaved from the polymer are analyzed by MS/MS. This strategy provides information concerning the best substrates for a particular target.
  • The synthesis of the β-sheet mimetic is illustrated by the retrosynthetic procedure shown next:
    Figure 00880001
  • The complexity of the library generated by this technique is (R1) (R3) (R) (Y) . Assuming R1, R3 and R are selected from naturally occurring amino acid side chains moieties, n is constant, and Y is H, Ac or -SO2R as defined above, a library having on the order of 24,000 members [(20) (20) (20)(3)] is generated.
  • After screening the library against a specific target (e.g., enzyme), the library may then recovered and screened with a second target, and so on.
  • In addition, a library of inhibitors can be constructed and screened in a standard chromogenic assay. For example, the library may be constructed as follows, where the following example is merely representative of the inhibitor libraries that may be prepared in an analogous manner to the specific example provided below.
    Figure 00890001
  • (See Wasserman et al., J. Org. Chem. 59:4364-6, 1994.)
  • A further alternative strategy is to link the library through the sidechain R group as shown below.
    Figure 00900001
    X = CF3, NHOH,
    Figure 00900002
    Figure 00900003
    Z = OR, NHR, or amino acids
  • A library of aspartic protease inhibitors may be constructed having the following exemplary structure, and then cleaved from the resin and screened:
    Figure 00900004
  • Similarly, for metalloproteases, a library having the exemplary structure shown below may be constructed and then cleaved from the resin to provide a library of hydroxamic acids:
    Figure 00910001
  • The activity of the β-sheet mimetics of this invention may be further illustrated by reference to Table 2 which lists a number of biologically active peptides. In particular, the peptides of Table 2 are known to have biological activity as substrates or inhibitors.
    Biologically Active Peptides
    Protease Inhibitors:
    (a) (D)FPR (Thrombin)
    Enzyme 40:144-48, 1988
    (b) (D)IEGR (Factor X)
    Handbook of Synthetic Substrates for the Coagulation and Fibronlytic Systems, H.C. Hemker, pp. 1-175, 1983, Martinus Nijhoff Publishers, The Hague.
    Protein Kinase Substrates and Inhibitors:
    (c) LRRASLG (Serine Kinase)
    Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 61:559, 1974
    (d) LPYA (Tyrosine Kinase)
    J. Bio. Chem. 263:5024, 1988
    (e) PKI (Serine Kinase)
    Science 253:1414-20, 1991
    CAAX Inhibitors:
    (f) (H)-CVIM-(OH)
    Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 88:732-36, 1991
    (g) (H)-CVFM-(OH)
    Bioorg. Med. Chem. Letters 4:887-92, 1994
    (h) (H)-CIT-(homoserine lactone)
    Science 260:1934-37, 1993
    SH2 Peptide Analogs;:
    (i) pYZPZSpYZPZS (IRS 1 analogue)
    Biochemistry 33:9376-81, 1994
    (j) EPQpYEEIPIYL (Src SH2 binding motif)
    Cell 72:767-68, 1993
    pY = phosphorylated Y
    Z = norleucine
    Class MHC I Peptides:
    (k) TYQRTRALV (Influenza nucleoprotein)
    J. Exp. Med. 175:481-87, 1991
    (l) RGYVYQGL (VSV)
    Ann. Rev. Imm. 11:211-44, 1993
  • More generally, the β-sheet mimetics of this invention can be synthesized to mimic any number of biologically active peptides by appropriate choice of the R2, R2', R3, F, Y and Z moieties (as well as the A, B, C, D and E moieties of structure (I) itself). This is further illustrated by Table 3 which discloses various modifications which may be made to the β-sheet mimetics of structure (I) to yield biologically active compounds. In Table 3, R2 and R3 are independently chosen from among the atoms or groups shown under the "R2/R3" column.
    Figure 00920001
    Figure 00930001
    Figure 00940001
    Figure 00950001
    Figure 00960001
    Figure 00970001
    Figure 00980001
    Figure 00990001
  • When the β-sheet mimetics of this invention are substituted for one or more amino acids of a biologically active peptide, the structure of the resulting β-sheet modified peptide (prior to cleavage from the solid support, such as PAM) may be represented by the following diagram, where AA1 through AA3 represent the same or different amino acids:
    Figure 00990002
    The precise β-sheet mimetic may be chosen by any of a variety of techniques, including computer modeling, randomization techniques and/or by utilizing natural substrate selection assays. The β-sheet mimetic may also be generated by synthesizing a library of β-sheet mimetics, and screening such library members to identify active members as disclosed above.
  • Once the optimized β-sheet mimetic is chosen, modification may then be made to the various amino acids attached thereto. A series of β-sheet modified peptides having a variety of amino acid substitutions are then cleaved from the solid support and assayed to identify a preferred substrate. It should be understood that the generation of such substrates may involve the synthesis and screening of a number of β-sheet modified peptides,
    wherein each β-sheet modified peptide has a variety of amino acid substitutions in combination with a variety of different β-sheet mimetics. In addition, it should also be recognized that, following cleavage of the β-sheet modified peptide from the solid support, the Z moiety is AA3 and the Y moiety is AA2 and AA1 in the above diagram. (While this diagram is presented for illustration, additional or fewer amino acids may be linked to the β-sheet mimetic - that is, AA3 may be absent or additional amino acids my be joined thereto; and AA2 and/or AA1 may be omitted or additional amino acids may be joined thereto).
  • Once a preferred substrate is identified by the procedures disclosed above, the substrate may be readily converted to an inhibitor by known techniques. For example, the C-terminal amino acid (in this case AA1) may be modified by addition of a number of moieties known to impart inhibitor activity to a substrate, including (but not limited to) -CF3 (a known reversible serine protease inhibitor), -CH2Cl (a known irreversible serine protease inhibitor), -CHN2 and -CH2S(CH3)2 + (known cysteinyl protease inhibitors), -NHOH (a known metalloprotease inhibitor),
    Figure 01000001
    (a known cysteinyl protease inhibitor), and
    Figure 01010001
    (a known aspartyl protease inhibitor).
  • While the utility of the β-sheet mimetics of this invention have been disclosed with regard to certain embodiments, it will be understood that a wide variety and type of compounds can be made which includes the β-sheet mimetics of the present invention. For example, a β-sheet mimetic of this invention may be substituted for two or more amino acids of a peptide or protein. In addition to improving and/or modifying the β-sheet structure of a peptide or protein, especially with regard to conformational stability, the β-sheet mimetics of this invention also serve to inhibit proteolytic breakdown. This results in the added advantage of peptides or proteins which are less prone to proteolytic breakdown due to incorporation of the β-sheet mimetics of this invention.
  • More specifically, the β-sheet mimetics of this invention have broad utility in naturally occurring or synthetic peptides, proteins and molecules. For example, peptides, proteins and molecules. For example, the β-sheet mimetics disclosed herein have activity as inhibitors of kinases and proteases, as well as having utility as MHC II inhibitors. For example, the β-sheet mimetics of this invention have activity as inhibitors of the large family of trypsin-like serine proteases, including those preferring arginine or lysine as a P' substituent. These enzymes are involved in hemostasis and include (but are not limited to) Factor VIIa, Factor IXa, Factor Xa, Factor XIa, thrombin, kallikrein, urokinase (which is also involved in cancer metastasis) and plasmin. A related enzyme, tryptase, is involved in inflammatory responses. Thus, the ability to selectively inhibit these enzymes has wide utility in therapeutic applications involving cardiovascular disease, inflammatory diseases, and oncology.
  • For example, compounds of the following structures represent further embodiments of this invention in the context of Factor VIIa and thrombin inhibitors.
  • Factor VIIa Inhibitors:
  • Figure 01020001
    Figure 01030001
    Figure 01040001
  • Thrombin Inhibitors:
  • Figure 01040002
    Figure 01050001
  • In another aspect, the present invention encompasses pharmaceutical compositions prepared for storage or administration which comprise a therapeutically effective amount of a β-sheet mimetic or compound of the present invention in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Anticoagulant therapy is indicated for the treatment and prevention of a variety of thrombotic conditions, particularly coronary artery and cerebrovascular disease. Those experienced in this- field are readily aware of the circumstances requiring anticoagulant therapy.
  • The "therapeutically effective amount" of a compound of the present invention will depend on the route of administration, the type of warm-blooded animal being treated, and the physical characteristics of the specific animal under consideration. These factors and their relationship to determining this amount are well known to skilled practitioners in the medical arts. This amount and the method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which as noted those skilled in the medical arts will recognize.
  • The "therapeutically effective amount" of the compound of the present invention can range broadly depending upon the desired affects and the therapeutic indication. Typically, dosages will be between about 0.01 mg/kg and 100 mg/kg body weight, preferably between about 0.01 and 10 mg/kg, body weight.
  • "Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers" for therapeutic use are well known in the pharmaceutical art, and are described, for example, in Remingtons Pharmaceutical Sciences, Mack Publishing Co. (A.R. Gennaro edit. 1985). For example, sterile saline and phosphate-buffered saline at physiological pH may be used. Preservatives, stabilizers, dyes and even flavoring agents may be provided in the pharmaceutical composition. For example, sodium benzoate, sorbic acid and esters of p-hydroxybenzoic acid may be added as preservatives. In addition, antioxidants and suspending agents may be used.
  • Thrombin inhibition is useful not only in the anticoagulant therapy of individuals having thrombotic conditions, but is useful whenever inhibition of blood coagulation is required such as to prevent coagulation of stored whole blood and to prevent coagulation in other biological samples for testing or storage. Thus, the thrombin inhibitors can be added to or contacted with any medium containing or suspected of containing thrombin and in which it is desired that blood coagulation be inhibited (e.g., when contacting the mammal's blood with material selected from the group consisting of vascular grafts, stems, orthopedic prosthesis, cardiac prosthesis, and extracorporeal circulation systems).
  • The thrombin inhibitors can be co-administered with suitable anti-coagulation agents or thrombolytic agents such as plasminogen activators or streptokinase to achieve synergistic effects in the treatment of various vascular pathologies. For example, thrombin inhibitors enhance the efficiency of tissue plasminogen activator-mediated thrombolytic reperfusion. Thrombin inhibitors may be administered first following thrombus formation, and tissue plasminogen activator or other plasminogen activator is administered thereafter. They may also be combined with heparin, aspirin, or warfarin.
  • The thrombin inhibitors of the invention can be administered in such oral forms as tablets, capsules (each of which includes sustained release or timed release formulations), pills, powders, granules, elixers, tinctures, suspensions, syrups, and emulsions. Likewise, they may be administered in intravenous (bolus or infusion), intraperitoneal, subcutaneous, or intramuscular form, all using forms well known to those of ordinary skill in the pharmaceutical arts. An effective but non-toxic amount of the compound desired can be employed as an anti-aggregation agent or treating ocular build up of fibrin. The compounds may be administered intraocularly or topically as well as orally or parenterally.
  • The thrombin inhibitors can be administered in the form of a depot injection or implant preparation which may be formulated in such a manner as to permit a sustained release of the active ingredient. The active ingredient can be compressed into pellets or small cylinders and implanted subcutaneously or intramuscularly as depot injections or implants. Implants may employ inert materials such as biodegradable polymers or synthetic silicones, for example, Silastic, silicone rubber or other polymers manufactured by the Dow-Corning Corporation.
  • The thrombin inhibitors can also be administered in the form of liposome delivery systems, such as small unilamellar vesicles, large unilamellar vesicles and multilamellar vesicles. Liposomes can be formed from a variety of phospholipids, such as cholesterol, stearylamine or phosphatidylcholines.
  • The thrombin inhibitors may also be delivered by the use of monoclonal antibodies as individual carriers to which the compound molecules are coupled. The thrombin inhibitors may also be coupled with soluble polymers as targetable drug carriers. Such polymers can include polyvinlypyrrolidone, pyran copolymer, polyhydroxy-propyl-methacrylamide-phenol, polyhydroxyethyl-aspartarnide-phenol, or polyethyleneoxide-polylysine substituted with palmitoyl residues. Furthermore, the thrombin inhibitors may be coupled to a class of biodegradable polymers useful in achieving controlled release of a drug, for example, polylactic acid, polyglycolic acid, copolymers of polylactic and polyglycolic acid, polyepsilon caprolactone, polyhydroxy butyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydibydropyrans, polycyanoacrylates and cross linked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.
  • The dose and method of administration can be tailored to achieve optimal efficacy but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which those skilled in the medical arts will recognize. When administration is to be parenteral, such as intravenous on a daily basis, injectable pharmaceutical compositions can be prepared in conventional forms, either as liquid solutions or suspensions, solid forms suitable for solution or suspension in liquid prior to injection, or as emulsions.
  • Tablets suitable for oral administration of active compounds of the invention can be prepared as follows:
    Amount-mg
    Active Compound 25.0 50.0 100.0
    Microcrystalline cellulose 37.25 100.0 200.0
    Modified food corn starch 37.25 4.25 8.5
    Magnesium stearate 0.50 0.75 1.5
  • All of the active compound, cellulose, and a portion of the corn starch are mixed and granulated to 10% corn starch paste. The resulting granulation is sieved, dried and blended with the remainder of the corn starch and the magnesium stearate. The resulting granulation is then compressed into tablets containing 25.0, 50.0, and 100.0 mg, respectively, of active ingredient per tablet.
  • An intravenous dosage form of the above-indicated active compounds may be prepared as follows:
    Active Compound 0.5-10.0mg
    Sodium Citrate 5-50mg
    Citric Acid 1-15mg
    Sodium Chloride 1-8mg
    Water for Injection (USP) q.s. to 1 ml
  • Utilizing the above quantities, the active compound is dissolved at room temperature in a previously prepared solution of sodium chloride, citric acid, and sodium citrate in Water for Injection (USP, see page 1636 of United States Pharmacopoeia/National Formulary for 1995, published by United States Pharmacopoeia Convention, Inc., Rockville, Maryland, copyright 1994).
  • Compounds of the present invention when made and selected as disclosed are useful as potent inhibitors of thrombin in vitro and in vivo. As such, these compounds are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents to prevent the clotting of blood and as in vivo pharmaceutical agents to prevent thrombosis in mammals suspected of having a condition characterized by abnormal thrombosis.
  • The compounds of the present invention are useful as in vitro diagnostic reagents for inhibiting clotting in blood drawing tubes. The use of stoppered test tubes having a vacuum therein as a means to draw blood obtained by venipuncture into the tube is well known in the medical arts (Kasten, B.L., "Specimen Collection," Laboratory Test Handbook, 2nd Edition, Lexi-Comp Inc., Cleveland pp. 16-17, Edits. Jacobs, D.S. et al. 1990). Such vacuum tubes may be free of clot-inhibiting additives, in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian serum from the blood they may alternatively contain clot-inhibiting additives (such as heparin salts, EDTA salts, citrate salts or oxalate salts), in which case, they are useful for the isolation of mammalian plasma from the blood. The compounds of the present invention are potent inhibitors of factor Xa or thrombin, and as such, can be incorporated into blood collection tubes to prevent clotting of the mammalian blood drawn into them.
  • The compounds of the present invention may be used alone, in combination of other compounds of the present invention, or in combination with other known inhibitors of clotting, in the blood collection tubes. The amount to be added to such tubes is that amount sufficient to inhibit the formation of a clot when mammalian blood is drawn into the tube. The addition of the compounds to such tubes may be accomplished by methods well known in the art, such as by introduction of a liquid composition thereof, as a solid composition thereof, or liquid composition which is lyophilized to a solid. The compounds of the present invention are added to blood collection tubes in such amounts that, when combined with 2 to 10 mL of mammalian blood, the concentration of such compounds will be sufficient to inhibit clot formation. Typically, the required concentration will be about 1 to 10,000 nM, with 10 to 1000 nM being preferred.
  • With respect to regulation of transcription factors, the compounds of this invention regulate transcription factors whose ability to bind to DNA is controlled by reduction of a cysteine residue by a cellular oxidoreductase. In one embodiment, the transcription factor is NF-κB. In this embodiment, the compounds of this invention have activity as mediators of immune and/or inflammatory responses, or serve to control cell growth. In another embodiment, the transcription factor is AP-1, and the cellular oxidoreductase is Ref-1. In this embodiment, the compounds of this invention have activity as anti-inflammatory and/or anticancer agents. In yet further embodiments, the transcription factor is selected from Myb and glucocorticoid receptor. Other transcription factors that may be regulated within the context of this invention also include: those of the NFkB family, such as Rel-A, c-Rel, Rel-B, p50 and p52; those of the AP-1 family, such as Fos, FosB, Fra-1, Fra-2, Jun, JunB and JunD; ATF; CREB; STAT-1, -2, -3, -4, -5 and -6; NEAT-1, -2 and -4; MAF; Thyroid Factor; IRF; Oct-1 and -2; NF-Y; Egr-1; and USF-43.
  • In the practice of the methods of this invention, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of this invention is administered to a warm-blooded animal in need thereof. For example, the compounds of this invention may be administered to a warm-blooded animal that has been diagnosed with, or is at risk of developing, a condition selected from Chrohns disease, asthma, rheumatoid arthritis, ischemia, reperfusion injury, graft versus host disease (GVHD), amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (ALS), Alzheimer's disease, allograft rejection and adult T-cell leukemia.
  • The following examples are offered by way of illustration, not limitation.
  • EXAMPLES Example 1 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetic
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a representative β-sheet mimetic of this intention.
  • Synthesis of structure (1):
  • Figure 01130001
  • Phenylalanine benzaldimine, structure (1), was synthesized as follows. To a mixture of L-phenylalanine methyl ester hydrochloride (7.19 g, 33.3 mmol) and benzaldehyde (3.4 ml, 33.5 mmol) stirred in CH2Cl2 (150 ml) at room temperature was added triethylamine (7.0 ml, 50 mmol). Anhydrous magnesium sulfate (2 g) was added to the resulting solution and the mixture was stirred for 14 h then filtered through a 1 inch pad of Celite with CH2Cl2. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to ca. one half of its initial volume then diluted with an equal volume of hexanes. The mixture was extracted twice with saturated aqueous NaHCO3, H2O and brine then dried over anhydrous Na2SO4 and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 8.32 g (93% yield) of colorless oil. 1H NMR analysis indicated nearly pure (>95%) phenylalanine benzaldimine. The crude product was used without further purification.
  • Synthesis of Structure (2):
  • Figure 01140001
  • α-Allylphenylalanine benzaldimine, structure (2), was synthesized as follows. To a solution of diisopropylamine (4.3 ml, 33 mmol) stirred in THF (150 ml) at -78°C was added dropwise a solution of n-butyllithium (13 ml of a 2.5 M hexane solution, 33 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred for 20 min. then a solution of phenylalanine benzaldimine (7.97 g, 29.8 mmol) in THF (30 ml) was slowly added. The resulting dark red-orange solution was stirred for 15 min. then allyl bromide (3.1 ml, 36 mmol) was added. The pale yellow solution was stirred for 30 min. at -78°C then allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred an additional 1 h. Saturated aqueous ammonium chloride was added and the mixture was poured into ethyl acetate. The organic phase was separated and washed with water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 8.54 g of a viscous yellow oil. Purification by column chromatography yielded 7.93 g (87%) of α-allylphenylalanine benzaldimine as a viscous colorless oil.
  • Synthesis of Structure (3) :
  • Figure 01150001
  • α-Allylphenylalanine hydrochloride, structure (3), was synthesized as follows. To a solution of α-allylphenylalanine benzaldimine (5.94 g, 19.3 mmol) stirred in methanol (50 ml) was added 5% aqueous hydrochloric acid (10 ml). The solution was stirred at room temperature for 2 h then concentrated under vacuum to an orange-brown caramel. The crude product was dissolved in CHCl3 (10 ml) and the solution was heated to boiling. Hexanes (∼150 ml) were added and the slightly cloudy mixture was allowed to cool. The liquid was decanted away from the crystallized solid then the solid was rinsed with hexanes and collected. Removal of residual solvents under vacuum yielded 3.56 g (72%) of pure α-allylphenylalanine hydrochloride as a white crystalline solid.
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.86 (3 H, br s), 7.32-7.26 (5H, m), 6.06 (1 H, dddd, J = 17.5, 10.5, 7.6, 7.3 Hz), 5.33 (1H. d, J = 17.5 Hz), 5.30 (1 H, d, J = 10.5 Hz), 3.70 (3 H, s), 3.41 (1 H, d, J = 14.1 Hz), 3.35 (1 H, d, J = 14.1 Hz), 2.98 (1 H, dd, J = 14.5, 7.3 Hz), 2.88 (1 H, dd, J = 14.5, 7.6 Hz).
  • Synthesis of Structure (4) :
  • Figure 01160001
  • N- tert-butyloxycarbonyl -α-allylphenylalanine, structure (4) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of D,L α-allylphenylalanine hydrochloride (565 mg, 2.21 mmol) stirred in a mixture of THF (15 ml) and water (5 ml) was added di-tert-butyl dicarbonate followed by careful addition of solid sodium bicarbonate in small portions. The resulting two phase mixture was vigorously stirred at room temperature for 2 days then diluted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was separated and washed with water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded a colorless oil that was purified by column chromatography (5 to 10% EtOAc in hexanes gradient elution) to yield 596 mg (86%) of N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-α-allylphenylalanine.
  • TLC Rf = 0.70 (silica, 20% EtOAc in hexanes); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.26-7.21 (3 H, m), 7.05 (2 H, d, J = 6.1 Hz), 5.64 (1 H, dddd, J = 14.8, 7.6, 7.2, 7.2 Hz), 5.33 (1 H, br s), 5.12-5.08 (2 H, m), 3.75 (3 H, s), 3.61 (1 H, d, J = 13.5 Hz), 3.21 (1 H, dd, J = 13.7, 7.2 Hz), 3.11 (1 H, d, J = 13.5 Hz), 2.59 (1 H, dd, J = 13.7, 7.6 Hz), 1.47 (9 H, s).
  • Synthesis of Structure (5) :
  • Figure 01170001
  • An aldehyde of structure (5) was synthesized as follows. Ozone was bubbled through a solution of 2.10 g (6.57 mmol) of the structure (4) olefin stirred at -78°C in a mixture of CH2Cl2 (50 ml) and methanol (15 ml) until the solution was distinctly blue in color. The solution was stirred an additional 15 min. then dimethyl sulfide was slowly added. The resulting colorless solution was stirred at -78°C for 10 min. then allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 6 h. The solution was concentrated under vacuum to 2.72 g of viscous pale yellow oil which was purified by column chromatography (10 to 20% EtOAc in hexanes gradient elution) to yield 1.63 g of pure aldehyde as a viscous colorless oil.
  • TLC Rf = 0.3 (silica, 20% EtOAc in hexanes); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.69 (1 H, br s), 7.30-7.25 (3 H, m,), 7.02 (2 H, m,), 5.56 (1 H, br s), 3.87 (1 H, d, J = 17.7 Hz,), 3.75 (3 H, s,), 3.63 (1 H, d, J = 13.2 Hz), 3.08 (1 H, d, J = 17.7 Hz), 2.98 (1 H, d, J = 13.2 Hz,), 1.46 (9 H, s,).
  • Synthesis of Structure (6):
  • Figure 01180001
  • A hydrazone of structure (6) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the aldehyde of structure (5) (1.62 g, 5.03 mmol) stirred in THF (50 ml) at room temperature was added hydrazine hydrate (0.32 ml, 6.5 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 10 min. then heated to reflux for 3 days. The solution was allowed to cool to room temperature then concentrated under vacuum to 1.59 g (105% crude yield) of colorless foam. The crude hydrazone product, structure (6), was used without purification.
  • TLC Rf = 0.7 (50% EtOAc in hexanes); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.55 (1 H, br s), 7.32-7.26 (3 H, m), 7.17 (1 H, br s), 7.09 (2H, m), 5.55 (1 H, br s), 3.45 (1 H, d, J = 17.7 Hz), 3.29 (1 H, d, J = 13.5 Hz), 2.90 (1 H, d, J = 13.5 Hz), 2.88 (1 H, dd, J = 17.7, 1.3 Hz), 1.46 (9 H, s) ; MS (CI+, NH3) m/z 304.1 (M + H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (7):
  • Figure 01180002
  • A cyclic hydrazide of structure (7) was synthesized as follows. The crude hydrazone of structure (6) (55 mg, 0.18 mmol) and platinum oxide (5 mg, 0.02 mmol) were taken up in methanol and the flask was fitted with a three-way stopcock attached to a rubber balloon. The flask was flushed with hydrogen gas three times, the balloon was inflated with hydrogen, and the mixture was stirred vigorously under a hydrogen atmosphere for 17 hours. The mixture was filtered through Celite with ethyl acetate and the filtrate was concentrated under vacuum to a white form. Purification of the white foam by flash chromatography yielded 44 mg of the pure cyclic hydrazide of structure (7) (80%).
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.34-7.28 (3 H, m), 7.21 (2 H, m), 6.95 (1 H, br s), 5.29 (1 H, br s), 3.91 (1 H, br s), 3.35 (1 H, d, J = 12.9 Hz), 3.00 (1 H, ddd, J = 13.9, 5.3, 5.0 Hz), 2.96 (1 H, d, J = 12.9 Hz), 2.67 (1 H, br m), 2.38 (1 H, br m), 2.30 (1 H, ddd, J = 13.9, 5.4, 5.0 Hz), 1.45 (9 H, s); MS (CI+, NH3) m/z 306.2 (M + H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (8) :
  • Figure 01190001
  • Structure (8) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the cyclic hydrazide of structure (7) (4.07 g, 13.32 mmol) stirred in ethyl acrylate (200 ml) at 90°C was added formaldehyde (1.2 mL of a 37% aqueous solution). The mixture was heated to reflux for 15 h then allowed to cool to room temperature and concentrated under vacuum to a white foam. The products were separated by column chromatography (5% then 10% acetone/chloroform) to yield 0.851 g of the least polar diastereomer of the bicyclic ester, structure (8b), and a more polar diastereomer (8a). The impure fractions were subjected to a second chromatography to afford more pure structure (8b), 25% combined yield.
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.27-7.21 (3 H, m), 7.09 (2 H, d, J = 6.5 Hz), 5.59 (1 H, br s), 4.52 (1 H, dd, J = 9.1, 3.4 Hz), 4.21 (2 H, m), 3.40 (1 H, d, J = 12.5 Hz), 3.32 (1 H, d, J = 12.5 Hz), 3.10 (2 H, m), 2.79 (1 H, br m), 2.66 (1 H, br m),2.79 (1 H, br m), 2.66 (1 H, br m), 2.54 (1 H, br m), 2.46 (1 H, m), 2.18 (1 H, m), 1.44 (9 H, s), 1.28 (3 H, t, J = 7.0 Hz); MS (CI+, NH3) 418.4 (M + H+).
    Figure 01200001
  • Synthesis of Structure (9b):
  • Figure 01200002
  • Structure (9b) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the least polar ethyl ester (i.e., structure (8b)) (31 mg, 0.074 mmol) stirred in THF (1 ml) was added aqueous lithium hydroxide (1 M, 0.15 ml). The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 h then the reaction was quenched with 5% aqueous citric acid. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x) then the combined extracts were washed with water and brine. The organic layer was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to a colorless glass. The crude acid, structure (9b), was used in subsequent experiments without further purification.
  • Synthesis of Structure (10b):
  • Figure 01210001
  • Structure (10b) was synthesized as follows. The crude acid of structure (9b) (30 mg, 0.074 mmol), HArg(PMC)pNA (41 mg, 0.074 mmol), and HOBt (15 mg, 0.098 mmol) were dissolved in THF (1 ml) then diisopropylethylamine (0.026 ml, 0.15 mmol) was added followed by EDC (16 mg, 0.084 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 4 h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine. The organic layer was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to 54 mg of pale yellow glass. The products were separated by column chromatography to yield 33 mg (50%) of a mixture of diastereomers of the coupled (i.e., protected) product, structure (10b). MS (CI+, NH3) m/z 566.6 (M + H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (11b) :
  • Figure 01220001
  • A (β-sheet mimetic of structure (11b) was synthesized as follows. A solution of 0.25 ml of H2O, 0.125 ml of 1,2-ethanedithiol and 360 mg of phenol in 5 ml of TFA was prepared and the protected product of structure (10b) (33 mg, 0.035 mmol) was dissolved in 2 ml of this solution. The resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 3 h then concentrated under reduced pressure. Ether was added to the concentrate and the resulting precipitate was collected by centrifugation. The precipitate was triturated with ether and centrifuged two more times then dried in a vacuum desiccator for 14 h. The crude product (14 mg) was purified by HPLC chromatography to yield the β-sheet mimetic of structure (11b). MS (CI+, NH3) m/z 954.8 (M + Na+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (12b) :
  • Figure 01230001
  • Structure (12b) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the crude acid of structure (9b) (24 mg, 0.062 mmol) and N-methylmorpholine (0.008 ml), stirred in THF (1 ml) at -50°C was added isobutyl chloroformate. The resulting cloudy mixture was stirred for 10 min. then 0.016 ml (0.14 mmol) of N-methylmorpholine was added followed by a solution of HArg(Mtr)CH2Cl (50 mg, 0.068 mmol) in THF (0.5 ml). The mixture was kept at -50°C for 20 min. then was allowed to warm to room temperature during 1 h. The mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate and brine. The organic layer was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to yield 49 mg of colorless glass, structure (12). Separation by column chromatography yielded 12 mg of a less polar diastereomer and 16 mg of a more polar diastereomer.
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.93 (1 H, br s), 7.39-7.31 (3 H, m), 7.16 (2 H, d, J = 6.9 Hz), 6.52 (1 H, s), 6.30 (1 H, br s), 5.27 (1 H, s), 4.74 (1 H, dd, J = 9.1, 6.9 Hz), 4.42 (1 H, br d, J = 6.8 Hz), 4.33 (1 H, d, J = 6.8 Hz), 3.82 (3 H, s), 3.28 (1 H, d, J = 13.3 Hz), 3.26-3.12 (4 H, m), 2.98 (1 H, d, J = 13.3 Hz), 2.69 (3 H, s), 2.60 (3 H, s), 2.59-2.33 (4 H, m), 2.25- 2.10 (3 H, m), 2.11 (3 H, s), 1.77 (1 H, br m), 1.70-1.55 (3 H, br m), 1.32 (9 H, s).
  • Synthesis of Structure (13b) :
  • Figure 01240001
  • A β-sheet mimetic of structure (13b) was synthesized as follows. The more polar diastereomer of structure (12b) (16 mg, 0.021 mmol) was dissolved in 95% TFA/H2O (1 ml) and the resulting solution was stirred at room temperature for 6 h then concentrated under vacuum to 11 mg of crude material. The crude product was triturated with ether and the precipitate was washed twice with ether then dried under high vacuum for 14 h. 1H NMR analysis indicated a 1:1 mixture of fully deprotected product and product containing the Mtr protecting group. The mixture was dissolved in 95% TFA/H2O and stirred for 2 days and the product was recovered as above. Purification of the product by HPLC yielded 5 mg of the pure compound of structure (13b). MS (EI+) m/z 477.9 (M+).
  • Example 2 (Comparative example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetic
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic of this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (14):
  • Figure 01250001
  • N,O-Dimethyl hydroxamate, structure (14), was synthesized as follows. To a mixture of Boc-Ng-4-methoxy-2,3,6-trimethylbenzenesulfonyl-L-arginine (8.26 g, 14.38 mmol), N,O-dimethylhydroxylamine hydrochloride (2.78 g, 28.5 mmol) and 1-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate (2.45 g, 16.0 mmol) stirred in THF (150 ml) at ambient temperature was added N,N-diisopropylethylamine (7.5 ml, 43 mmol) followed by solid EDC (3.01 g, 15.7 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred for 16h then diluted with ethyl acetate (200 ml) and extracted sequentially with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine. The organic solution was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 7.412 g of white foam.
  • 1H NMR (500Mhz, CDCl3): δ 6.52 (1 H, s), 6.17 (1 H, br s), 5.49 (1 H, d, J=8.8Hz), 4.64 (1 H, br t), 3.82 (3H, s), 3.72 (3H, s), 3.36 (1 H, br m), 3.18 (3H, s), 3.17 (1 H, br m), 2.69 (3H, s), 2.61 (3H, s), 2.12 (3H, 2), 1.85-1.55 (5 H, m), 1.41 (9 H, s); MS (FB+): m/z 530.5 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (15) :
  • Figure 01260001
  • Structure (15) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the arginine amide (7.412 g, 13.99 mmol) stirred in dichloromethane (150 ml) at room temperature was added N,N-diisopropylethylamine (2.9 ml, 17 mmol) followed by di-tert-butyldicarbonate (3.5 ml, 15.4 mmol) and N,N-dimethylaminopyridine (0.175 g, 1.43 mmol). The resulting solution was stirred for 1.5h then poured into water. The aqueous layer was separated and extracted with two 100ml portions of dichloromethane. The combine extracts were shaken with brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded a white foam that was purified by flash chromatography to yield 8.372 g of white foam.
  • 1H MMR (500MHz, CDCl3): δ 9.79 (1 H, s), 8.30 (1 H, t, J=4.96), 6.54 (1 H, s), 5.18 (1 H, d, J=9.16 Hz), 4.64 (1 H, m) , 3.83 (3 H, s), 3.74 (3 H, s), 3.28 (2 H, dd, J=12.6, 6.9 Hz), 3.18 (3 H, s), 2.70 (3 H, s), 2.62 (3 H, s), 2.14 (3 H, s), 1.73-1.50 (5 H, m), 1.48 (9H, s), 1.42 (9 H, s); MS (FB+): m/z 630.6 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (16) :
  • Figure 01270001
  • The arginal, structure (16), was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the arginine amide structure (15) stirred in toluene at -78°C under a dry argon atmosphere was added a solution of diisobutylaluminum hydride in toluene (1.0 M, 7.3ml) dropwise over a period of 15 minutes. The resulting solution was stirred for 30 minutes then a second portion of diisobutylaluminum hydride (3.5ml) was added and stirring was continued for 15 minutes. Methanol (3ml) was added dropwise and the solution was stirred at -78°C for 10 minutes then allowed to warm to room temperature. The mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate (100ml) and stirred vigorously with 50 ml of saturated aqueous potassium sodium tartrate for 2.5h. The aqueous phase was separated and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 100ml). The extracts were combined with the original organic solution and shaken with brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded a white foam that was separated by flash chromatography to yield 1.617g of the aldehyde as a white foam.
  • 1H NMR (500MHz, CDCl3): δ 9.82 (1 H, s), 9.47 (1 H, s), 8.35 (1 H, br t), 6.55 (1 H, s), 5.07 (1 H, d, J=6.9 Hz), 4.18 (1 H, br m), 3.84 (3 H, s), 3.25 (2 H, m), 2.70 (3 H, s), 2.62 (3 H, s), 2.14 (3 H, s), 1.89 (1 H, m), 1.63- 1.55 (4 H, m), 1.49 (9H, s), 1.44 (9 H, s); MS (FB+): m/z 571.6 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (17):
  • Figure 01280001
  • Hydroxybenzothiazole, structure (17), was synthesized as follows. To a solution of benzothiazole (1.55 ml, 14 mmol) stirred in anhydrous diethyl ether (60 ml) at -78°C under a dry argon atmosphere was added a solution of n-butyllithium (2.5 M in hexane, 5.6 ml, 14 mmol) dropwise over a period of 10 minutes. The resulting orange solution was stirred for 45 minutes then a solution of the arginal structure (16) (1.609 g, 2.819 mmol) in diethyl ether (5ml) was slowly added. The solution was stirred for 1.5 h then saturated aqueous ammonium chloride solution was added and the mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 100 ml) and the combined extracts were extracted with water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded a yellow oil that was purified by flash chromatography (30% then 40% ethyl acetate/hexanes eluent) to yield 1.22 g of the hydroxybenzothiazoles (ca. 2:1 mixture of diastereomers) as a white foam.
  • The mixture of hydroxybenzothiazoles (1.003 g, 1.414 mmol) was stirred in CH2Cl2 (12 ml) at room temperature and trifluoroacetic acid (3 ml) was added. The resulting solution was stirred for 1.5h then concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 1.22 g of the benzothiazolylarginol trifluoroacetic acid salt as a yellow foam.
       MS (EI+): m/z 506.2 (M + H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (18b):
  • Figure 01290001
  • The bicyclic compound, structure (18b) was synthesized as follows. The bicyclic acid of structure (9b) from Example 1 (151 mg, 0.387 mmol) and HOBt hydrate (71 mg, 0.46 mmol) were dissolved in THF (5 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.34 ml, 1.9 mmol) was added followed by EDC (89 mg, 0.46 mmol). After stirring for ten minutes a solution of the benzothiazolylarginol trifluoroacetic acid salt (structure (17) 273 mg, 0.372 mmol) in THF (1 ml) was added along with a THF (0.5 ml) rinse. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 15 h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted sequentially with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine. The organic solution was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to 297 mg of a yellow glass. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of four diastereomeric amides which included structure (18b).
       MS (ES+) : m/z 877 (M+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (19b) :
  • Figure 01300001
  • Structure (19b) was synthesized as follows. The crude hydroxybenzothiazole (247 mg, 0.282 mmol) was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (5 ml) and Dess-Martin periodinane (241 mg, 0.588 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 6h then diluted with ethyl acetate and stirred vigorously with 10% aqueous sodium thiosulfate for 10 minutes. The organic solution was separated and extracted with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 252 mg of yellow glass. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of two diastereomeric ketobenzothiazoles which included structure (19b).
  • Synthesis of Structure (20b):
  • Figure 01310001
  • The ketobenzothiazole, structure (20), was synthesized as follows. Ketobenzothiazole (19) (41 mg, 0.047 mmol) was dissolved in 95% aqueous trifluoroacetic (0.95 ml) acid and thioanisole (0.05 ml) was added. The resulting dark solution was stirred for 30 hours at room temperature then concentrated under vacuum to a dark brown gum. The gum was triturated with diethyl ether and centrifuged. The solution was removed and the solid remaining was triturated and collected as above two more times. The yellow solid was dried in a vacuum desiccator for 2 hours then purified by HPLC (Vydac reverse phase C-4 column (22 x 250 mm ID). Mobile phase: A = 0.05% TFA in water; B = 0.05% TFA in acetonitrile. The flow rate was 10.0 mL/min. The gradient used was 8% B to 22% B over 25 min, and isochratic at 22% thereafter. The peak of interest (structure (20b)) eluted at 42 minutes) to give 2.5 mg of the deprotected product, structure (20b).
       MS (ES+) : 563.5 (M + H+).
  • Example 3 (Comparative Example) Activity of a Representative β-Sheet Mimetic as a Proteolytic Substrate
  • This example illustrates the ability of a representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention to selectively serve as a substrate for thrombin and Factor VII. The β-sheet mimetic of structure (11b) above was synthesized according the procedures disclosed in Example 1, and used in this experiment without further modification.
  • Both the thrombin and Factor VII assays of this experiment were carried out at 37°C using a Hitachi UV/Vis spectrophotometer (model U-3000). Structure (11b) was dissolved in deionized water. The concentration was determined from the absorbance at 342 nm. Extinction coefficient of 8270 liters/mol/cm was employed. The rate of structure (11b) hydrolysis was determined from the change in absorbance at 405 nm using an extinction coefficient for p-nitroaniline of 9920 liters/mol/cm for reaction buffers. Initial velocities were calculated from the initial linear portion of the reaction progress curve. Kinetic parameters were determined by unweighted nonlinear least-squares fitting of the simple Michaelis-Menten equation to the experimental data using GraFit (Version 3.0, Erithacus Software Limited).
  • For the thrombin assay, experiments were performed in pH 8.4 Tris buffer (Tris, 0.05M; NaCl, 0.15M). 6.4 NIH units of bovine thrombin (from Sigma) were dissolved into 10 ml of the assay buffer to yield 10 nM thrombin solution. In a UV cuvette, 130 to 148 µl of the buffer and 100 µl of the thrombin solutions were added, preincubated at 37°C for 2 minutes, and finally 2 to 20 microliters (to make the final volume at 250 µl) of 0.24 mM structure (11b) solution was added to initiate the reaction. The first two minutes of the reactions were recorded for initial velocity determination. Eight structure (11b) concentration points were collected to obtain the kinetic parameters. kcat and KM were calculated to be 50 s-1 and 3 µM, respectively. kcat/KM was found to be 1.67x107 M-1 s-1.
  • For the Factor VII assay, pH 8.0 Tris buffer (0.05 M Tris, 5 mM CaCl2, 0.15 M NaCl, 0.1% TWEEN 20, 0.1% BSA) was used. 10 µl of 20 µM human Factor VIIa (FVIIa) and 22 µM of human tissue factor (TF) was brought to assay buffer to make 160 nM FVIIa and TF solutions, respectively. 40 to 48 µl of buffer, 25 µl of FVIIa and 25 µl TF solution were added to a cuvette, and incubated at 37°C for 5 minutes, then 2 to 10 µl of 2.4 mM structure (11b) solution was added to the cuvette to initiate reaction (final volume was 100 ml). The initial 3 minutes reaction progress curves were recorded. Five structure (11b) concentration points were collected. The initial rates were linear least-square fitted against the concentrations of structure (11b) with GraFit. The kcat/KM was calculated from the slope and found to be 17,500 M-1s-1.
  • In both the thrombin and Factor VII assay of this experiment, (D)FPR-PNA was run as a control. Activity of structure (11b) compared to the control was 0.76 and 1.38 for thrombin and Factor VII, respectively (Factor VII: Kcat/KM = 1.27 x 104 M-1 S-1; thrombin: Kcat/KM = 2.20 x 107 M-1 S-1).
  • Example 4 (Comparative Example) Activity of a Representative β-Sheet Mimetic as a Protease Inhibitor
  • This example illustrates the ability of a representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention to function as a protease inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, urokinase, tissue plasminogen activator (t-PA), protein C, plasmin and trypsin. The β-sheet mimetic of structure (13b) above was synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Example 1, and used in this experiment.
  • All inhibition assays of this experiment were performed at room temperature in 96 well microplates using a Bio-Rad microplate reader (Model 3550). 0.29 mg of structure (13b) was dissolved into 200 ml of 0.02 N hydrochloric acid deionized water solution. This solution (2.05 mM) served as the stock solution for all the inhibition assays. The hydrolysis of chromogenic substrates was monitored at 405 nm. The reaction progress curves were recorded by reading the plates typically 90 times with 30 seconds to 2 minute intervals. The initial rate were determined by unweighted nonlinear least-squares fitting to a first order reaction in GraFit. The determined initial velocities were then nonlinear least-square fitted against the concentrations of structure (13b) using GraFit to obtain IC50. Typically, eight structure (13b) concentration points were employed for IC50 determination.
  • For the thrombin assay, N-p-tosyl-Gly-Pro-Arg-pNA (from Sigma) was used at 0.5 mM concentration in 1% DMSO (v/v) pH 8.4 Tris buffer as substrate. From structure (13b) stock solution two steps of dilution were made. First, 1:2000 dilution into 0.02 N hydrochloride solution, then 1:100 dilution into pH 8.4 Tris buffer. The final dilution of structure (13b) served as the first point (10 nM). Seven sequential dilutions were made from the first point with a dilution factor of 2. Into each reaction well, 100 µl of 10 nM thrombin solution and 50 µl of structure (13b) solution was added. The mixture of the enzyme and inhibitor was incubated for 20 minutes, then 100 µl of 0.5 mM substrate solution was added to initiate the reaction. The IC50 of structure (13b) against thrombin was found to be 1.2±0.2 nM.
  • In the Factor VII assay, S-2288 (from Pharmacia), D-Ile-Pro-Arg-pNA was used at 20 µM in deionized water as substrate. From the stock of structure (13b), a 1:100 dilution was made into pH 8.0 Tris buffer. This dilution served as the first point of the inhibitor (20 µM). From this concentration point 6 more sequential dilutions were made with a dilution factor of 2. 50 µl of 16 nM FVIIa and TF complex solution and 40 µl of the inhibitor solutions were added into each well, the mixtures were incubated for 20 minutes before 10 µl of 20 mM S-2288 was added. IC50 of structure (13b) against factor VII was found to be 140±3 nM.
  • In the Factor X assay, buffer and substrate are the same as used for thrombin assay. A 1:100 dilution was made into pH 8.4 Tris buffer to serve as the first point. Seven dilutions with a dilution factor of 2 were made. The assay protocol is the same as for thrombin except 25 nM of bovine factor Xa (from Sigma) in pH 8.4 Tris buffer was used instead of thrombin. IC50 of structure (13b) against factor X was found to be 385±17 nM.
  • In the urokinase assay, buffer was pH 8.8 0.05 M Tris and 0.05 M NaCl in deionized water. S-2444 (from Sigma), pyroGlu-Gly-Arg-pNA at 0.5 mM in water was utilized as substrate. The same dilution procedure was used as for Factor VII and Factor X. Assay protocol is the same as for thrombin except 18.5 nM of human urokinase (from Sigma) was utilized. IC50 was found to be 927±138 nM.
  • Tissue Plasminogen Activator (t-PA): Buffer, substrate and the dilution scheme of structure (13b) were the same as utilized for Factor VII assay.
  • Activated Protein C (aPC): Buffer was the same as used in thrombin assay. 1.25 mM S-2366 in the assay buffer was utilized as substrate. Dilutions of structure (13b) were the same as in urokinase assay.
  • Plasmin: Buffer (see thrombin assay); S-2551 (from Pharmacia), D-Val-Leu-Lys-pNA at 1.25 mM in assay buffer was utilized as substrate. For dilutions of structure (13b) (see urokinase assay).
  • In the trypsin assay, pH 7.8 Tris (0.10 M Tris and 0.02 M CaCl2) was utilized as the buffer. BAPNA (from Sigma) was used at 1 mg/ml in 1% DMSO (v/v) deionized water solution as substrate. The same dilutions of structure (13b) were made as for Factor VII assay. 40 µl of 50 µg/ml bovine trypsin (from Sigma) and 20 µl of structure (13b) solution were added to a reaction well, the mixture was incubated for 5 minutes before 40 µl of 1 mg/ml BAPNA was added to initiate the reaction. The IC50 of structure (13b) against trypsin was found to be 160±8 nM.
  • In the above assays, (D)FPR-CH2Cl ("PPACK") was run as a control. Activity of structure (13b) compared to the control was enhanced (see Table 4).
    IC50 (nM)
    Enzymes PPACK Structure (13b)
    Thrombin 1.5 1.2
    Factor VII 200 140
    Factor X 165 385
    Protein C 281 528
    Plasmin 699 978
    Trypsin 212 16
    Urokinase 508 927
    t-PA 106 632
  • With respect to prothrombin time (PT), this was determined by incubating (30 minutes at 37°C) 100 µl of control plasma (from Sigma) with 1-5 µl of buffer (0.05 M Tris, 0.15 M NaCl, pH=8.4) or test compound (i.e., PPACK or structure (13b)) in buffer. Then 200 µl of prewarmed (at 37°C for ∼10 minutes) thromboplastin with calcium (from Sigma) was rapidly added into the plasma sample. The time required to form clot was manually recorded with a stop watch (see Table 5), and was found to be comparable with PPACK.
    PT (second)
    Concentration PPACK Structure (13b)
    0 (Control) 13 13
    1 pM -- 13
    10 pM -- 17
    50 pM -- 18
    100 pM -- 23
    200 pM -- 24
    500 pM 15 27
    1 nM 18 30
    10 nM 22 31
    20 nM 25 --
    30 nM -- 31
    40 nM 28 --
    50 nM -- 30
    60 nM 30 --
    80 nM 31 33
  • Example 5 (Comparative Example) Activity of a Representative β-Sheet Mimetic as a Protease Inhibitor
  • This example illustrates the ability of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, urokinase, Tissue Plasminogen Activator, Activated Protein C, plasmin, tryptase and trypsin. The β-sheet mimetic of structure (20b) above was synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Example 2, and used in this experiment.
  • All inhibition assays were performed at room temperature in 96 well microplates using Bio-Rad microplate reader (Model 3550). A 1 mM solution of structure (20b) in water served as the stock solution for all the inhibition assays. The hydrolysis of chromogenic substrates was monitored at 405 nm. The reaction progress curves were recorded by reading the plates, typically 60 times with 30 second to 2 minute intervals. Initial rates were determined by unweighted nonlinear least-squares fitting to a first order reaction in GraFit (Erithacus Software Limited, London, England). The determined initial velocities were then nonlinear least-square fitted against the concentrations of structure (20b) using GraFit to obtain Ki. The general format of these assays are: 100 ml of a substrate solution and 100 ml of structure (20b) solution were added in a microplate well, then 50 ml of enzyme solution was added to initiate the reaction. Typically, eight structure (20b) concentration points were employed for Ki determination. The values of Ki of structure (20b) against nine serine proteases are tabulated in Table 6.
  • Thrombin: N-p-tosyl-Gly-Pro-Arg-pNA (from Sigma) was used at 0.5 mM concentration in 1% DMSO (v/v) pH8.0 tris buffer (tris, 50 mM, TWEEN 20, 0.1%, BSA, 0.1%, NaCl, 0.15 M, CaCl2, 5 mM) as substrate. From structure (20b) stock solution two steps of dilution were made, first, 1:100 dilution in water, then 1:50 dilution in the pH8.0 tris buffer to serve as the first point (200 nM). Seven sequential dilutions were made from the first point for the assay.
  • Factor VII: S-2288 (from Pharmacia), D-Ile-Pro-Arg-pNA was used at 2.05 mM in the pH 8.0 tris buffer (see thrombin assay). From the stock of structure (20b), a 1:100 dilution was made in the tris buffer. From this concentration point seven more sequential dilutions were made for the assay.
  • Factor X: Buffer and substrate were the same as used for thrombin assay. A 1:100 dilution was made -in the pH8.0 tris buffer to serve as the first point. Seven more dilutions from the first were made for the assay.
  • Urokinase: Buffer, 50 mM tris, 50 mM NaCl, pH=8.8. S-2444 (from Sigma), pyroGlu-Gly-Arg-pNA at 0.25 mM in buffer was utilized as substrate. 1:10 dilution in buffer was made from the stock of structure (20b) as the first point, then seven more dilutions from the first point were made for the assay.
  • Tissue Plasminogen Activator (t-PA): Buffer, substrate and the dilution scheme of structure (20b) were the same as utilized for Factor VII assay.
  • Activated Protein C (aPC): Buffer was the same as used in thrombin assay. 1.25 mM S-2366 in the assay buffer was utilized as substrate. Dilutions of structure (20b) were the same as in urokinase assay.
  • Plasmin: Buffer (see thrombin assay); S-2251 (from Pharmacia), D-Val-Leu-Lys-pNA at 1.25 mM in assay buffer was utilized as substrate. For dilutions of structure (20b) (see urokinase assay).
  • Tryptase: 0.1 M tris, 0.2 M NaCl, 0.1 mg/ml heparin, pH=8.0 was utilized as buffer. 0.5 mM S-2366 (from Pharmacia), L-pyroGlu-Pro-Arg-pNA in buffer was used as substrate. From the 1 mM stock of structure (20b), 10 mM solution was made in water, then 1 mM solution was made in buffer from the 10 mM solution to serve as the first concentration point. From this point seven more dilutions were made for the assay.
  • Trypsin: Buffer, substrate and the dilution scheme of structure (20b) were the same as used for thrombin.
    Ki (nM)
    Enzyme Source Assay Conc.(nM) Structure (20b)
    thrombin bovine plasma 2 0.66
    factor VII human 4 270
    factor X bovine plasma 8 966
    urokinase human kidney 3.7 600
    t-PA human 10 495
    APC human plasma 1 3320
    plasmin bovine plasma 4 415
    tryptase human lung 2 12.4
    trypsin bovine pancreas 5 0.64
  • As illustrated by the data presented in Table 6 above, structure (20b) functioned as a good thrombin inhibitor, with good specificity against fibrinolytic enzymes.
  • Example 6 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetic
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention having the following structure (21) :
    Figure 01420001
  • Structure (21) was synthesized as follows. A solution of 48 mg (0.859 mmol) Na-FMOC-Ne-Cbz-a-ethanal-Lys-Ome [synthesized from Ne-Cbz-Lys-OMe by the same method used for the preparation of structure (5) from Phe-OMe], 15.9 mg (0.0859 mmol) Cys-OEt.HCl and 13.2 µL (0.0945 mmol) TEA were in 0.43 mL CH2Cl2 were stirred under Ar for 2 hr at room temperature. Bis(bis(trimethylsilyl)amino)tin(II) (39.8 µL) was added and the reaction stirred overnight. The reaction solution was diluted with 10 mL EtOAc and washed with 6 mL each 10% citrate, water, and brine. The organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtered, and concentrated. The resulting residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica gel using 40% EtOAc/hexanes to give, after drying in vacuo, 12.9 mg of colorless oil (23%) as a mixture of diastereomers by 1H NMR (CDCl3). MS ES(+) m/z 658.2 (MH+, 30), 675.3 (M + Na+, 100), 696.1 (M + K+, 45).
  • Example 7 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetic
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (22) :
  • Figure 01430001
  • Structure (22) was synthesized as follows. To a stirred solution of Cbz-Glu(OBn)-OH (5 g, 13.5 mmol) with DMAP (270 mg) and methanol (3 ml) in dichloromethane (100 ml) was added EDCI (3g) at 0°C. After stirring at 0°C for 3h, the solution was stirred at room temperature (rt) overnight. After concentration, the residue was taken up into EtOAc (100 ml) and 1N HCl (100 ml). The aqueous phase was separated and extracted with EtOAc (100 ml). The combined organic extracts were washed with sat. NaHCO3 (100 ml), brine (100 ml), dried (MgSO4), passed through a short pad of silica gel, and concentrated to provide 4.95 g an oil (95%). The product was pure enough to use for the next reaction without any further purification. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 2.00 (m, 1H), 2.25 (m, 1H), 2.50 (m, 2H), 3.74 (s, 3H, OCH3), 4.42 (m, 1H, CHNH), 5.10 and 5.11 (two s, 4H, CH2Ph), 5.40 (d, 1H, NH), 7.35 (s, 10H, phenyls); MS CI(isobutane) m/z 386 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (23) :
  • Figure 01430002
  • Structure (23) was synthesized as follows: To a stirred solution of L-Glu-OH (4.41g, 30 mmol) with triethylamine (8.4 ml, 60 mmol) in 1,4-dioxane (40 ml) and H2O (20 ml) was added Boc2O (7 g, 32 mmol) at rt. After stirring for 1.5h, the solution was acidified with 6N HCl (pH 2), and extracted with EtOAc (3x100 ml). The combined organic extracts were washed with H2O (100 ml), brine (50 ml), dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to provide an oil (9.5 g). Without further purification, the oil was used in the next reaction.
  • A mixture of above oil (9.5 g) with paraformaldehyde (5 g) and p-TsOH·H2O (400 mg) in 1,2-dichloroethane (200 ml) was heated at reflux with a Dean-Stark condenser, which was filled with molecular sieve 4A, for 6h. After addition of EtOAc (100 ml) and sat. NaHCO3 (50 ml), the solution was extracted with sat. NaHCO3 (3x50 ml). The combined aqueous extracts were acidified with 6N HCl (pH 2), and extracted with EtOAc (3x100 ml). The combined organic extracts were washed with brine (100 ml), dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to provide an oil. The crude oil was purified by flash chromatography (hexane:EtOAc = 80:20 to 70:30 to 60:40) to provide an oil (4.04 g, 52%) which solidified slowly upon standing. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.49 (s, 9H, C(CH3)3), 2.18 (m, 1H, -CH 2CH2), 2.29 (m, 1H, CH 2CH2), 2.52 (m, 2H, -CH2CH 2-), 4.33 (m, 1H, NHCHCH2), 5.16 (d, 1H, J = 4.5 Hz, NCH2O), 5.50 (br, 1H, NCH2O) ; 13C NMR (CDCl3) δ 25.85, 28.29, 29.33, 54.16, 79.10, 82.69, 152.47, 172.37, 178.13; MS (ES+) m/z 260 (M+H+), 282 (M+Na+), 298 (M+K+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (24):
  • Figure 01450001
  • Structure (24) was synthesized as follows. To a stirred solution of 1,1,1,3,3,3-hexamethyldisilazane (2.1 ml, 10 mmol) in THF (10 ml) was added n-BuLi (4 ml of 2.5M in hexane, 10 mmol) at 0°C. The resulting solution was stirred at the same temperature for 30 min. After cooling to -78°C, to this stirred solution was added a solution of carboxylic acid (23) (1.02 g, 3.94 mmol) in THF (10 ml) followed by rinsings of the addition syringe with 5 ml THF. The resulting solution was stirred at -78°C for 1h, and PhCH2Br (0.46 ml, 3.9 mmol) was added. After stirring at -30°C for 3h, to this solution was added 1N HCl (50 ml) and the resulting solution was extracted with EtOAc (100 ml). The organic extract was washed with brine (50 ml), dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to provide an oil. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (hexane:EtOAc = 80:20 to 60:40 to 50:50) to provide a foamy solid (1.35 g, 98%): 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.55 and 1.63 (two s, 9H, ratio 1.5:1 by rotamer, OC(CH3)3), 2.2-2.4 (m, 3H, -CH 2CH 2-), 2.6-2.9 (set of m, 1H, -CH2CH 2-), 3.04 (d, 1H, J = 13.5Hz, -CH2Ph), 3.33 and 3.58 (two d, 1H, J = 13 Hz, ratio 2:1, -CH2Ph), 4.03 (two d, 1H, J = 4Hz, A of ABq, -NCH2O-), 4.96 (two d, 1H, J = 4Hz, B of ABq, -NCH2O-); MS (ES-) m/z 348 (M-H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (25) :
  • Figure 01460001
  • Synthesis of structure (25) was carried out as follows. To a stirred solution of carboxylic acid (24) (1.05 g, 3.0 mmol) in dry THF (5 ml) was added 1,1'-carbonyldiimidazole (500 mg, 3.1 mmol) at rt. The resulting solution was stirred at rt for 30 min. The solution of acyl imidazole was used for the next reaction without purification.
  • Meanwhile, to a stirred solution of 1,1,1,3,3,3-hexamethyldisilazane (1.6 ml, 7.5 mmol) in THF (5 ml) was added n-BuLi (3 ml of 2.5 M solution in hexane, 7.5 mmol) at 0°C. After stirring at the same temperature for 30 min, the solution was cooled to -78°C. To the stirred solution was added a solution of Cbz-Glu(OBn)-OMe (1.16 g, 3 mmol) in THF (5 ml) followed by rinsings of the addition syringe with 2 ml THF. The resulting solution was stirred at the same temperature for 15 min. To this stirred solution was added the above acyl imidazole in 3 ml THF. After stirring 30 min. at -78°C, to this solution was added sat. NH4Cl (50 ml) and extracted with EtOAc (2x75 ml). The combined organic extracts were washed with sat. NaHCO3 (50 ml), brine (50 ml), dried (Na2SO4), passed through a short pad of silica gel, and concentrated to provide an oil. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (hexane: EtOAc = 90:10 to 80:20 to 70:30 to 60:40) to provide an oil (1.48 g, 69%): MS (ES+) m/z 734.4 (M+NH4 +).
  • Synthesis of Structure (26a):
  • Figure 01470001
  • Structure (26a) was synthesized as follows. A stirred solution of above starting keto ester (25) (530 mg, 0.7mmol) in EtOH/AcOH (10/l ml) was treated with 10% Pd/C (ca. 100 mg) under 20 atm pressure of H2 for 2 days. After filtration through a short pad of Celite, the filtrate was concentrated and dissolved in EtOAc (50 ml). The solution was washed with 1N HCl (30 ml), sat. NaHCO3 (30 ml), brine (30 ml), dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to provide an oil. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (hexane: EtOAc = 80:20 to 60:40 to 50:50 to 20:80 to 0:100) to provide a foamy solid (95 mg, 34%). TLC (EtOAc) Rf 0.68; NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.38 (two s, 9H, OC(CH3)3), 1.63 (s, 1H), 1.75 (m, 2H), 2.05 (m, 5H), 2.1-2.3 (set of m, 1H), 3.00 (d, 1H, J = 14 Hz, CH2Ph), 3.21 (d, 1H, J = 13.5 Hz, CH2Ph), 3.74 (collapsed two s, 4H, OCH3 and NCH), 4.53 (d, 1H, J = 9.5 Hz), 5.01 (br, 1H, NH); MS (ES+) m/z 403 (M+H+), 425 (M+Na+). Stereochemistry was assigned by 2D NMR.
  • Synthesis of Structure (27a):
  • Figure 01470002
  • Structure (27a) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of 28 mg (0.070 mmol) of the bicyclic ester (26a) stirred in 1 ml THF at room temperature was added 0.14 ml 1.0 M aqueous lithium hydroxide solution. The mixture was stirred vigorously for 20 h then quenched with 5% aqueous citric acid (1 ml). The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 25 ml) then the combined extracts were washed with water and brine and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. Filtration and concentration of the filtrate under vacuum gave 26 mg of white foam, used without further purification.
  • Synthesis of Structure (28a) :
  • Figure 01480001
  • Structure (28a) was synthesized as follows. The bicyclic acid (27a) (26 mg, 0.067 mmol), benzothiazolylarginol trifluoroacetic acid salt (structure (17) 61 mg, 0.083 mmol) EDC (21 mg, 0.11 mmol) and HOBt hydrate (16 mg, 0.10 mmol) were dissolved in THF (5 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.34 ml, 1.9 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 15h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted sequentially with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine. The organic solution was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to 60 mg of a yellow glass. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of four diastereomeric amides. MS (ES+): m/z 898 (M + Na+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (29a):
  • Figure 01490001
  • A β-sheet mimetic of structure (29a) was synthesized as follows. The crude hydroxybenzothiazole (28a) (60 mg, 0.068 mmol) was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (2 ml) and Dess-Martin periodinane (58 mg, 0.14 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 6h then diluted with ethyl acetate and stirred vigorously with 10% aqueous sodium thiosulfate for 10 minutes. The organic solution was separated and extracted with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 42 mg of yellow glass. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of two diastereomeric ketobenzothiazoles.
  • The ketobenzothiazole (42 mg, 0.048 mmol) was dissolved in 95% aqueous trifluoroacetic (0.95 ml) acid and thioanisole (0.05 ml) was added. The resulting dark solution was stirred for 18 hours at room temperature then concentrated under vacuum to a dark brown gum. The gum was triturated with diethyl ether and centrifuged. The solution was removed and the solid remaining was triturated and collected as above two more times. The yellow solid was dried in a vacuum desiccator for 2 hours then purified by HPLC to give 1.4 mg of the deprotected product. MS (ES+) : 562.4 (M + H+). HPLC: (tR=21.17 min.)
  • Synthesis of Structure (26b) :
  • Figure 01500001
  • Structure (26b) was synthesized as follows. A stirred solution of above starting keto ester (25) (615 mg, 0.86 mmol) in MeOH/AcOH (10/1 ml) was treated with 10 % Pd/C (ca. 60 mg) under 20 atm pressure of H2 for 3 days. After filtration through a short pad of Celite, the filtrate was concentrated to provide an oil. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (hexane : EtOAc =80 : 20 to 60 :40 to 50:50 to 0:100) to collect the more polar fraction (50 mg). Rf 0.12 (hexane: EtOAc=60:40); MS (ES+) m/z 433 (M+H+).
  • Above oil was treated with p-TsOH·H2O (5 mg) in 1,2-dichloroethane (10 ml) at reflux temperature for 2 days. After concentration, the oily product was purified by preparative TLC (hexane: EtOAc = 80:20 to 60:40) to give an oil (10 mg). TLC Rf 0.36 (hexane : EtOAc =60:40); 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.43 (s, 9H), 1.66 (m, 3H), 1.89 (m, 3H), 2.14 (m, 1H), 2.75 (m, 1H), 2.98 (m, 1H, CHN), 3.72 (s, 3H, Me), 4.30 (m, 1H), 5.59 (d, 1H, NH), 7.1-7.3 (m, 5H, phenyl); MS CI(NH3) 403.2 (M+H+). Stereochemistry was assigned by 2D NMR.
  • Synthesis of Structure (28b):
  • Figure 01510001
  • Structure (28b) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of 12 mg (0.030 mmol) of the bicyclic ester (26b) stirred in THF 1 ml at room temperature was added 0.060 ml 1.0 M aqueous lithium hydroxide solution. The mixture was stirred vigorously for 25h then quenched with 5% aqueous citric acid (1 ml). The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 25 ml) then the combined extracts were washed with water and brine and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. Filtration and concentration of the filtrate under vacuum gave 19 mg of white foam.
  • The foam, benzothiazolylarginol trifluoroacetic acid salt (30 mg, 0.041 mmol) EDC (10 mg, 0.052 mmol) and HOBt hydrate (9 mg, 0.059 mmol) were dissolved in THF (2 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.026 ml, 0.15 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 30h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted sequentially with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine. The organic solution was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to 28 mg of a yellow glass. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of four diastereomeric amides. MS (ES+) : m/z 898 (M + Na+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (29b):
  • Figure 01520001
  • Structure (29b) was synthesized as follows. The crude hydroxybenzothiazole (28b) (28 mg) was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (2 ml) and Dess-Martin periodinane (29 mg, 0.071 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 18h then diluted with ethyl acetate and stirred vigorously with 10% aqueous sodium thiosulfate for 10 minutes. The organic solution was separated and extracted with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine then dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 32 mg of yellow glass. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of two diastereomeric ketobenzothiazoles.
  • The ketobenzothiazole (32 mg) was dissolved in 95% aqueous trifluoroacetic (0.95 ml) acid and thioanisole (0.05 ml) was added. The resulting dark solution was stirred for 20 hours at room temperature then concentrated under vacuum to a dark brown gum. The gum was triturated with diethyl ether and centrifuged. The solution was removed and the remaining solid was triturated and collected as above two more times. The yellow solid was dried in a vacuum desiccator for 2 hours then purified by HPLC to give 1.3 mg of the deprotected product. MS (FB+): 562.36 (M + H+) ; HPLC: tR=21.51 min. (Gradient 0 to 90% 0.1% TFA in CH3CN / 0.1% TFA in H2O over 40 min.)
  • Example 8 (Comparative Example) Activity of Representative β-Sheet Mimetic as a Protease Inhibitor
  • This example illustrates the ability of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, Factor XI, and trypsin. The β-sheet mimetics of structures (29a) and (29b) above were synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Example 7, and used in this experiment.
  • The proteinase inhibitor assays were performed as described in Example 5 except as described below for Factor XI. The results are presented in Table 7.
  • Factor XI. The same buffer was utilized in this assay as in the thrombin assay. 1 mM S-2366 (from Pharmacia), L-pyroGlu-Pro-Arg-pNA, solution in water was used as substrate. From a 1mM stock solution of structure (29a) or (29b) in water, a 1:10 dilution was made in buffer. From this 100 µM solution, seven serial 1:5 dilutions were made in buffer for assay.
    Ki (nM)
    Enzymes Structure (29a) Structure (29b)
    Thrombin 10.4 0.085
    Trypsin 0.54 0.20
    Factor VII 1800 -
    Factor X 4600 17
    Factor XI 391 -
  • Example 9 (Comparative Example) Activities of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics as a Protease Inhibitor
  • This example illustrates the ability of further representative β-sheet mimetics not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, Factor XI, tryptase, aPC, plasmin, tPA, urokinase and trypsin. The β-sheet mimetics of structures (20) and (29b) above were synthesized according to the procedures disclosed in Examples 2 and 7, respectively, and used in this experiment.
  • The proteinase inhibitor assays were performed as described in Example 5 except as described in Example 8 for Factor XI. The results are presented in Table 8.
    Figure 01550001
  • Example 10 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (30) :
  • Figure 01560001
  • Structure (30) was synthesized as follows. n-Butyllithium (700 µL, 1.75 mmol, 2.5M in hexanes) was added over 5 min to a solution of tris(methylthio)methane (256 µL, 1.95 mmol) in THF (1 ml) at -78 °C. The mixture was stirred for 40 min then treated with a solution of bis-Boc-argininal (structure (16) from Example 2) (100 mg, 1.75 mmol) in 2 ml THF, dropwise, over a period of 5 min. After stirring for 1.5 h, the reaction was quenched with saturated NH4Cl solution and allowed to warm to room temperature. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer extracted with EtOAc (3x), washed with brine (1x), dried (Na2SO4) and concentrated. Purification by flash chromatography (EtOAc:Hexane 1:4) yielded 93 mg (73%) of the orthothiomethyl ester (structure (30)) and 8 mg of recovered aldehyde (structure (16)). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3.) δ 9.80 (s, 1H), 8.32 (t, J = 5.0 Hz, 1H), 6.54 (s, 1H), 5.23 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1H), 4.0 (m, 1H), 3.84 (s, 3H), 3.64 (br s, 1H), 3.38 (br s, 1H), 3.31 (m, 2H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.62 (s, 3H), 2.19 (s, 9H), 2.14 (s, 3H), 1.68-1.50 (m, 4H), 1.49 (s, 9H), 1.43 (s, 9H).
  • Synthesis of Structure (31):
  • Figure 01570001
  • Structure (31) was synthesized as follows. A mixture of 77 mg (0.11 mmol) of the orthothiomethyl ester (structure (30)), 117 mg (0.43 mmol) of mercuric chloride, and 39 mg (0.18 mmol) of mercuric oxide in 2.5 ml of 12:1 methanol/water was stirred at rt for 4 h. The mixture was filtered through Celite and the residue washed with EtOAc (3x). The filtrate was diluted with water and extracted with EtOAc (3x). The organic layer was washed twice with 75% NH4OAc/NH4Cl, then with NH4Cl and dried (Na2SO4). The solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/Hex, 1:3) to give 48 mg (72%) of the two diastereomers of structure (31) in a 1:2.7 ratio. 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) (major diastereomer) δ 9.80 (s, 1H), 8.33 (t, J = 5.0 Hz, 1H), 6.54 (s, 1H), 4.66 (d, J = 10.5 Hz, 1H), 4.08 (dd, J = 5.0, 2.0 Hz, 1H), 3.97 (m, 1H), 3.84 (s, 3H), 3.77 (s, 3H), 3.30 (m, 2H), 3.06 (d, J = 5.0 Hz, 1H), 2.70 (s, 3H), 2.63 (s, 3H), 2.14 (s, 3H), 1.68-1.50 (m, 4H), 1.49 (s, 9H), 1.40 (s, 9H); MS (ES+) m/z 631.5 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (32):
  • Figure 01580001
  • Structure (32) was synthesized as follows. A solution of 32 mg of the methyl ester (structure (31)) (0.051 mmol) in THF/water (4 ml, 1:3) was treated with 5 mg (0.119 mmol) of LiOH·H2O. After stirring for 45 min, the reaction was diluted with 5% citric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (3x). The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to give 30 mg (96%) of structure (32) as a white solid. The product was used without further purification. 1 H NMR 500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.80 (br s, 1H), 8.29 (br s, 1H), 6.54 (s, 1H), 5.62 (br s, 1H), 4.08 (m, 1H), 3.82 (s, 3H), 3.27 (br s, 3H), 2.69 (s, 3H), 2.62 (s, 3H), 2.13 (s, 3H), 1.65-1.50 (m, 4H), 1.48 (s, 9H), 1.37 (s, 9H); MS (ES-) m/z 615.5 (M-H*) .
  • Synthesis of Structure (33) :
  • Figure 01590001
  • Structure (33) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of the compound of structure (32) (29 mg, 0.047 mmol), HOBt (8 mg, 0.056 mmol) and EDC (11 mg, 0.056 mmol) in THF (5 ml), phenethylamine (7 ml, 0.056 mmol) was added followed by diisopropylethylamine (12 µL, 0.071 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at rt overnight and diluted with 5% citric acid. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous phase extracted with EtOAc (3x). The combined extracts were washed with a saturated solution of NaHCO3, brine, dried over Na2SO4, and filtered. After concentration the crude product was purified by chromatography (EtOAc/Hex, 1:1) to give 26 mg (77%) of structure (33) over two steps. 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.84 (s, 1H), 8.34 (t, J = 5 Hz, 1H), 7.28 (m, 3H), 7.21 (m, 2 H), 7.04 (m, 1H), 6.55 (s, 1H), 5.16 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1H), 4.56 (d, J = 5 Hz, 1H), 4.11 (dd, J = 5.0, 3.0 Hz, 1H), 3.98 (m, 1H), 3.84 (s, 3H), 3.66 (m, 1H), 3.51 (m, 2H), 3.17 (m, 1H), 2.81 (t, J = 7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.71 (s, 3H), 2.65 (s, 3H), 2.14 (s, 3H), 1.68-1.52 (m, 4H), 1.49 (s, 9H), 1.39 (s, 9H); MS (FAB+) m/z 720.6 (M+H+) (FAB-) m/z 718.5 (M-H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (34):
  • Figure 01600001
  • Structure (34) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of phenethylamide (structure (33), 25 mg, 0.035 mmol) in THF (5 ml) was added 18 mg of p-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate (0.093 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at rt overnight to give a baseline spot by TLC. The solution was concentrated in vacuo, and the residue washed twice with ether removing excess pTsOH to give structure (34) as a yellowish-white solid, which was used without further purification. 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) was consistent with the expected product, however, individual peak assignment was difficult due to broadening. MS (ES+) m/z 520.4 (M+H+).
  • Structure (34) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (35) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • Example 11 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (36):
  • Figure 01610001
  • Structure (36) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to compound (34) starting with benzylamine and structure (32). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) was consistent with the expected product, however, individual peak assignment was difficult due to broadening. MS (FAB+) m/z 506.4 (M+H+).
  • Structure (36) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (37) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • Example 12 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (38) :
  • Figure 01620001
  • Structure (38) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to structure (34) starting with p-chlorophenethylamine and structure (32). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) was consistent with the expected product, individual peak assignment was difficult due to broadening. MS (ES+) m/z 554.5 (M+H+).
  • Structure (38) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (39) as'identified in Table 9 below.
  • Example 13 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (40) :
  • Figure 01630001
  • Structure (40) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to compound (34) using p-methoxyphenethylamine and structure (32). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) was consistent with the expected product, however, individual assignment was difficult due to broadening. MS (ES+) m/z 550.5 (M+H+).
  • Structure (40) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (41) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • Example 14 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (42):
  • Figure 01640001
  • Structure (42) was prepared as follows. In a 10 ml round-bottomed flask were added CH2Cl2 (10 ml), methyl 2,3 -dimethylaminopropionate dihydrochloride (19.9 mg, 0.103 mmol, 1.5 eq), and diisopropylethylamine (53 ml, 0.304 mmol, 4.4 eq). This suspension was stirred magnetically at room temperature for 1 h at which time was added the compound of structure (30) (50 mg, 0.068 mmol, 1 eq), mercury(II)chloride (82.4 mg, 0.304 mmol, 4.4 eq), and mercury(II)oxide (25.7 mg, 0.120 mmol, 1.7 eq). The resulting yellow suspension was stirred for 16.5 h during which time the suspension turned gray. The reaction was diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 ml), washed with saturated aqueous NH4Cl (5 ml), saturated aqueous NaCl (5 ml) and dried over Na2SO4. The cloudy suspension was filtered and the solvent removed in vacuo. The white solid was purified on preparative thin-layer chromatography to produce the imidazoline structure (42) (25.3 mg, 52% yield) as a clear amorphous solid.: Rf 0.11 (10% MeOH/CHCl3); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.82 (s, 0.6H, N'H, mixture of tautomers), 9.78 (s, 0.4H, N"H), 8.35 (dd, J=4.3, 11 Hz, 1H, N-5), 6.54 (s, 1H, ArH), 5.08 (d, J= Hz, 1H, CHOH), 4.52 (m, 1H, imidazoline CH2), 4.38 (d, J=21 Hz, 1H), 3.8-4.0 (m, 2H), 3.86 (s, 3H, CO2CH 3), 3.767 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.5-3.7 (m, 2H, C-5 CH 2), 3.16-3.27 (m, C-5 CH 2), 2.70 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.63 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.14 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.5-1.7 (m, 4H, C-3 and C-4 CH2), 1.49 (s, 9H, Boc), 1.46 (s, 9H, Boc); IR (film) 1725.56, 1685.68, 1618.36, 1585.45, 1207.09, 1148.85 cm-1; MS (ES+) m/e 699.4 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (43) :
  • Figure 01650001
  • Structure (43) was synthesized as follows. In a 25 ml round-bottomed flask was placed the compound of structure (42) (230 mg, 0.33 mmol), CHCl3 (5 ml) and MnO2 (500 mg, 5.75 mmol, 17.4 eq). After stirring for 5 h the suspension was filtered and the solid washed with methanol. The solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (5 ml) and methanol (1 ml) and a fresh portion of MnO2 (500 mg) was introduced and the reaction stirred for 15 h at room temperature. The solid was filtered and the solvent removed in vacuo. The residue was purified via column chromatography on silica gel, eluting with 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexane, then pure ethyl acetate, then 1:9 methanol:ethyl acetate to obtain the desired product (structure (43), 190 mg, 83% yield) as an amorphous solid.: Rf 0.64 (70:30-ethyl acetate:hexane); 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 10.70 (bs, 1H, imidazole NH), 9.70 (s, 1H), 8.28 (s, 1H) , 7.84 (s, 1H), 6.54 (s, 1H, ArH), 5.35 (m, 1H, aH), 5.25 (s, 1H, BocNH), 3.926 (s, 3H), 3.840 (s, 3H), 3.15-3.40 (m, 2H), 2.682 (s, 3H), 2.133 (s, 3H), 1.52-1.70 (m, 4H), 1.470 (s, 9H), 1.424 (s, 9H); IR (film) 1724.68, 1619.03, 1277.72, 1151.93, 1120.61 cm-1; MS (ES+) m/e 695.2 (M+H+, 22), 717.2 (M+Na+, 100).
  • Synthesis of Structure (44):
  • Figure 01660001
  • Structure (44) was synthesized by the same method used to construct structure (33) to structure (34). The product was used in the coupling without further purification.
  • Structure (44) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the deprotection of structure (19) respectively) to provide structure (45) as identified in Table 9 below. In the preparation of structure (45), the coupling step was performed with the carbonyl compound of structure (44), rather than with the analogous hydroxy compound.
  • Example 15 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (46):
  • Figure 01670001
  • Structure (46) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to structure (17) starting from structure (16) and thiazole. This compound was used in the coupling step without further purification.
  • Structure (46) was reacted with structure (9a) of Example 1 (in an analogous manner to the procedure described in Example 2 for the synthesis of structure (18)), followed by oxidation and deprotection (in an analogous manner as described with respect to the oxidation and deprotection of structures (18) and (19), respectively) to provide structure (47) as identified in Table 9 below.
  • Example 16 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (48) :
  • Figure 01680001
  • To a solution of α-Boc-β-Fmoc-2,3-diaminopropionic acid (818 mg, 1.92 mmol) stirred in THF (5 ml) at -25°C was added 4-methylmorpholine (0.23 ml, 2.1 mmol) followed by isobutylchloroformate (0.25 ml, 1.9 mmol). The resulting suspension was stirred for 5 minutes and then filtered with the aid of 5 ml of THF. The filtrate was cooled in an ice/water bath then sodium borohydride (152 mg, 0.40 mmol) dissolved in water (2.5 ml) was added dropwise. The mixture was stirred for 15 minutes then water (50 ml) was added and the mixture was extracted with CH2Cl2 (3 x 50 ml). The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded a pale yellow solid that was purified by flash chromatography (50% ethyl acetate/hexanes eluent) to give 596 mg of the alcohol as a white solid.
  • The alcohol (224 mg, 0.543 mmol) was dissolved in methylene chloride and Dess-Martin periodinane (262 mg, 0.64 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 1 h then diluted with ethyl acetate (50 ml) and extracted sequentially with 10% aqueous Na2S2O3, saturated aqueous NaHCO3, and brine. The organic solution was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to a white solid. Purification of the solid by flash chromatography yielded 169 mg of the aldehyde structure (48) as a white solid.
  • Synthesis of Structure (49) :
  • Figure 01690001
  • Structure (49) was synthesized in an analogous fashion to structure (17) starting from structure (48) and benzothiazole. This compound was used as a 1:1 mixture of diastereomers in the coupling step (described below) without further purification. MS (EI+): m/z 446.4 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (50):
  • Figure 01700001
  • Structure (49) and bicyclic acid structure (9a) (27 mg, 0.069 mmol) and HOBt hydrate (71 mg, 0.46 mmol) were dissolved in THF (1 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.0.059 ml, 0.34 mmol) was added followed by EDC (19 mg, 0.099 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 20 h then diluted with ethyl acetate and extracted sequentially with 5% aqueous citric acid, saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, water and brine. The organic solution was dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under vacuum to 61 mg of a yellow foam. 1H NMR analysis indicated a mixture of diastereomeric amides.
  • The foam was dissolved in CH3CN and diethylamine was added. The solution was stirred at room temperature for 30 minutes then concentrated under vacuum to a yellow foam. The foam was rinsed with hexanes and dissolved in DMF (0.5 ml). In a separate flask, carbonyldiimidazole (16 mg, 0.99 mmol) and guanidine hydrochloride (10 mg, 0.10 mmol) were dissolved in DMF (1 ml) and diisopropylethylamine (0.035 ml, 0.20 mmol) was added followed by DMAP (1 mg). The solution was stirred for 1.5 h at room temperature then the solution of amine was added and stirring was continued for 16 h. The solution was concentrated under vacuum then water was added to the residue and the mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 25 ml). The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate and filtered. Concentration of the filtrate under vacuum yielded 58 mg of structure (50) as a yellow foam. MS (ES+): m/z 680.6 (M+H+).
  • Structure (50) was oxidized to provide the corresponding ketone of structure (51).
  • Example 17 (Comparative Example) Activities of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics as a Protease Inhibitor
  • This example illustrates the ability of further representative β-sheet mimetics not according to this invention to function as an inhibitor for thrombin, Factor VII, Factor X, Factor XI, tryptase, aPC, plasmin, tPA, urokinase thrombin thrombomodulin complex and trypsin. The β-sheet mimetics of the structures listed in Table 9 had the inhibition activities shown in Table 10.
  • The proteinase inhibitor assays were performed as described in Example 9. The assay for thrombin-thrombomodulin complex was conducted as for thrombin except that prior to the addition of inhibitor and substrate, thrombin was preincubated with 4 nM thrombomodulin for 20 minutes at room temperature.
    Figure 01720001
    Figure 01730001
    Figure 01740001
  • Example 18 (Comparative Example) Effect of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics on Platelet Deposition in a Vascular Graft
  • The effect of compounds on platelet deposition in a vascular graft, was measured according to the procedure of Hanson et al. "Interruption of acute platelet-dependent thrombosis by synthetic antithrombin D-phenylalanyl-L-prolyl-L-arginyl chloromethylketone" Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA 85:3148-3188, (1988), except that the compound was introduced proximal to the shunt as described in Kelly et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA 89:6040-6044 (1992). The results are shown in Figures 1, 2 and 3 for structures (20b), (39) and (29b), respectively.
  • Example 19 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetic not according to this invention having the structure shown below.
    Figure 01750001
  • Structure (52) may be synthesized employing the following intermediate (53) in place of intermediate (16) in Example 2:
    Figure 01760001
  • Intermediate (53) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 01760002
  • Alternatively, intermediate (53) may be synthesized by the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 01770001
  • Example 20 (Comparative Example) Representative β-Sheet Mimetics Which Bind to MHC I and MHC II
  • The following structures (54), (55) and (56) were synthesized by the techniques disclosed herein.
  • The ability of structures (54) and (55) to bind to MHC I molecules can be demonstrated essentially as described by Elliot et al. (Nature 351:402-406, 1991). Similarly, the ability of structure (56) to bind to MHC II molecules can be demonstrated by the procedure of Kwok et al. (J. Immunol. 155:2468-2476, 1995).
    Figure 01780001
    Figure 01790001
  • Example 21 (Comparative Example) Representative β-Sheet Mimetics Which Bind The SH2 Domain
  • The following structure (57) was synthesized, and structure (58) may be synthesized, by the techniques disclosed herein.
    Figure 01800001
  • MS ES(-) 104.3 (M-H+)-; HPLC Rt 17.28' (0-90% acetonitrile/H2O, 0.1% TFA)
    Figure 01800002
  • The ability of structure (58) to bind to the SH2 domain of STAT6, or of structure (57) to bind the SH2 domain of the protein tyrosine phosphatase SH-PTP1 can be demonstrated by the procedures disclosed by Payne et al. (PNAS 90:4902-4906, 1993). Libraries of SH2 binding mimetics may be screened by the procedure of Songyang et al. (Cell 72:767-778, 1993).
  • Example 22 (Comparative Example) Representative β-Sheet Mimetics Which Bind Protein Kinases
  • The following structure (59) may be synthesized by the techniques disclosed herein.
    Figure 01810001
  • The ability of structure (59) to act as a substrate or inhibitor of protein kinases may be demonstrated by the procedure of Songyang et al. (Current Biology 4:973-982, 1994).
  • Example 23 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of representative β-sheet mimetics not according to this invention having the following structures (60) through (63), wherein B is N or CH:
    Figure 01820001
    Figure 01820002
  • Synthesis of structure (60) :
  • Figure 01830001
  • Synthesis of structure (61) :
  • Figure 01840001
  • Alternative synthesis of structure (61):
    Figure 01850001
  • Synthesis of structure (62) :
  • Figure 01860001
  • Alternative synthesis of structure (62):
    Figure 01870001
  • Synthesis of structure (63) :
  • Figure 01880001
  • Example 24 (Comparative Example) Bioavailability of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the bioavailability of the compound of structure (20b) as synthesized in Example 2 above, and having the biological activity reported in Example 9 above.
  • Specifically, a pharmacodynamic and pharmacokinetic study of structure (20b) was conducted in male Sprague Dawley rats. Rats were administered a saline solution of structure (20b) at 4mg/kg intravenously (IV) or 10mg/kg orally (PO). Groups of rats (n = 3 or 4) were sacrificed and exsanguinated at 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4 and 8 hours following dosing. Efficacy parameters, aPTT and TT, were measured for each plasma sample. Concentrations of structure (20b) in plasma were determined by a trypsin inhibition assay. The results of this experiment are presented in Figures 4A and 4B for dosing of 4mg/kg IV and 10mg/kg PO, respectively. The data presented in Figures 4A and 4B illustrate in vivo efficacy of structure (20b) via both IV and PO administration. Non-compartmental pharmacokinetic analysis of mean structure (20b) concentration values demonstrate terminal halflives of 7.5 hr (IV) and 4.5 hr (PO). The bioavailability of orally administered structure (20b) is approximately 27%.
  • Example 25 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of a further representative β-sheet mimetics not according to this invention having the structure shown below.
  • Synthesis of Structure (64):
  • Figure 01900001
  • Structure (64) was synthesized as follows. A 150 ml round bottom flask was charged with 5.19 grams (24.7 mmol) of 1,2,3-benzene tricarboxylic acid, 75 ml of toluene, and 3.3 mL (24.7 mmol) of triethyl amine. The reaction was heated at reflux for 3 hours with the azeotropic removal water. At this time 2.07 ml of aniline was added, and the reaction again refluxed for six hours with the azeotropic removal of water. Upon cooling the reaction solution a crystalline product formed and was filtered off (4.68 g). The solution was then extracted with NaHCO3 and ethyl acetate, and the bicarbonate layer acidified and reextracted with a second EtOAc wash. The organic layer was dried over NaSO4, filtered, and the solvent removed to give an additional 1.24 grams of product. The total yield was 5.92 g (82%). 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 7.41, (d, 2H, J = 10 Hz), 7.48 (t, 1H, J = 10 Hz), 7.55 (t, 2H, J = 10 Hz), 7.98 (t, 1H, J = 10 Hz ), 8.20 (d, 1H, J = 10 Hz), 8.70 (d, 1H, J = 10 Hz); MS (ES-): 266 (M - H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (65) :
  • Figure 01900002
  • Structure (65) was synthesized as follows. The imide-acid of structure (64) (53.4 mg, 0.2 mmol) in THF (2 ml) was cooled to -40 °C and treated with 24.2 µl (0.22 mmol) of NMM and 28.2 µl IBCF (0.22 mmol). The reaction was stirred for 3 minutes and then 0.69 ml (0.69 mmol) of a 1 M solution of diazomethane in ether was added. The temperature was slowly raised to -20 degrees, and the reaction stirred for 2 h at this temperature. The reaction was warmed to 0 °C and stirred for 3 h more.
  • The reaction was diluted with EtOAc (30ml) and the organic phase washed with 5% citric acid, NaHCO3, and saturated NaCl. It was then dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to give 62.4 mg of residue. This crude product was dissolved in THF, cooled to -40 °C, and treated with 74 ul of a 4 M solution of HCl in dioxane. The reaction was warmed to -20 °C and stirred for 1 h. Subsequently the reaction was stirred for 2 h at 0 °C. TLC of the reaction mixture at this point showed disappearance of the starting diazoketone. The solvent was removed, and the product purified by preparative TLC (EtOAc/hexanes, 7/3) to give 22.6 mg (38%) of pure chloromethylketone. 1H NMR (CDCl3 δ 4.93 (s, 2H), 7.35-7.60 (m, 5H), 7.9 (m, 2H), 8.12 (dd, 1H, J = 9, 1.8 Hz); MS (EI): 299.1 (M+), 264.0 (M+ - Cl), 250.2 (M+ - CH2Cl).
  • Synthesis of Structure (66):
  • Figure 01910001
  • Structure (66) was synthesized as follows. To a stirred suspension of 910 mg (5.14 mmol) of 4-phenyl urazole in 50 ml of methylene chloride, was added 1.654 g (5.14 mmol) of iodobenzene diacetate. A deep red color developed, and with stirring, all material went into solution. After stirring for 15 minutes at room temperature, 560 mg of 90% pure 2,4-penatdienoic acid was added and the color gradually faded as a white solid formed. After fifteen minutes an additional 70 mg of pentadienoic acid was added. After stirring for 2 h at room temperature, the methylene chloride was removed under reduced pressure. Ether was added (25 ml) and the resulting suspension was cooled to -20 °C and solid material (1.41 g, 100%) filtered off. The product could be recrystallized from EtOAc/cyclohexane. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 4.04, (d, 1H, J = 20 Hz), 4.40 (d, 1H, J = 20 Hz), 5.17 (s, 1 H), 6.13 (m, 2H) 7.4-7.5 (m, 5H); MS (ES-): 271.9 (M - H+), 228.1 (M - CO2H).
  • Synthesis of Structure (67) :
  • Figure 01920001
  • Structure (67) was synthesized as follows. The Diels-Alder adduct of structure (66) (432 mg, 1.57 mmol) was mixed with 150 mg 10% Pd/C in 50 ml MeOH. The reaction was stirred overnight under a hydrogen atmosphere (hydrogen balloon). After 18 h, an aliquot (1 ml) was removed and the solvent evaporated under reduced pressure. 1H NMR of the residue showed greater than 95% conversion to the saturated product. The reaction mixture was filtered through celite, and the solvent removed via rotary evaporator, to give 424 mg of crystalline product. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.72 (m, 1H), 1.91 (m, 1H), 2.02 (m, 1H), 2.31 (m, 1H) 3.18 (m, 1H), 4.18 (d, 1H, J = 10 Hz), 4.88 (d, 1H, J = 12 Hz), 7.35-7.5 (m, 5H); MS (ES-) 274 (M - H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (66):
  • Figure 01930001
  • Structure (68) was synthesized as follows. To a solution of 450 mg (1.64 mmol) of (67) in 40 ml of methylene chloride was added 142 µL of oxalyl chloride (1.64 mmol) and a drop of DMF. The reaction was stirred at room temperature overnight under Ar. The methylene chloride was removed via rotary evaporator and 30 ml of THF added. This solution was cooled to -20 degrees and 2 ml of a 1 M solution of diazomethane in ether added. This was stirred 4 h, while gradually warming to room temperature. The reaction was then cooled to -78 degrees, and 500 uL of 4 M HCl in dioxane added. The reaction was again stirred under Ar while gradually warming to room temperature. Solvents were removed under reduced pressure to give a mixture (by 1H NMR analysis) of chloromethylketone and methyl ester. This was chromatographed on silica gel (EtOAc) to give 185 mg (36%) of chloromethylketone. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.62 (m, 1H), 1.86 (m, 1H), 2.08 (m, 1H), 2.39 (m, 1H), 3.26 (m, 1H), 3.97 (m, 1H), 4. 20 (1/2 of AB quartet, 1H, J = 15 Hz), 4.26 (1/2 of AB quartet, 1H, J = 15 Hz), 4.94 (m, 1H), 7.35-7.55 (m, 5H); MS (ES+): 308 (M + H+), 330 (M + Na+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (69):
  • Figure 01940001
  • Structure (69) was synthesized as follows. To 4-phenyl urazole (1.179 g, 6.65 mmol) in 60 ml methylene chloride 2.14 g of iodobenzene diacetate (6.64 mmol) was added and the reaction mixture stirred at room temperature. A deep red color developed as all the solids gradually dissolved. After about 15 minutes, 640 mg of sorbinal (6.66 mmol) in 10 ml methylene chloride was added to the reaction flask, and the red color slowly faded. After two hours, the methylene chloride was removed under reduced pressure. Ether (30 ml) was added to the resulting residue, and cooled to -20 degrees overnight. The solid material (1.55 g, 86% yield) formed was collected on filter paper. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.54 (d, 3H, J = 7.5 Hz), 4.57 (m, 1H), 4.90 (m, 1H) 5.86 (m, 1 H), 6.09 (m, 1 H), 7.38 (m, 1H), 7.50 (t, 2H), 7.58, (m, 2H), 9.6 (s, 1H); MS (CI, NH3): 272 (M + H+), 289 (M + NH4 +).
  • Synthesis of Structure (70):
  • Figure 01940002
  • To 0.78 grams (3.0 mmol) of the acid of structure (64) in a 100 ml round-bottomed flask was added 20 ml THF and the reaction mixture was cooled to -20 C. 4-Methyl morpholine (0.34 ml, 3.0 mmol) was added and was followed by the addition of 0.42 ml (3.3 mmol) isobutylchloroformate. The resultant suspension was stirred for 5 min, and then a suspension of 0.34 grams (9.0 mmol) of sodiumborohydride in 0.9 ml water was added rapidly. After 4-5 min, 40 ml of water were added and the suspension was extracted with 125 ml of ethylacetate. The EtOAc layer was then washed with water and brine and dried over MgSO4. Filtration and solvent evaporation provided the crude alcohol.
  • The crude alcohol was dissolved in 40 ml dichloromethane and 2.0 grams (4.7 mmol) of Dess-Martin periodinane reagent were added at room temperature. The reaction was stirred for 2 h, diluted with 40 ml dichloromethane and washed with 3 x 20 ml 1:1 (by volume) solution of 10% sodiumbicarbonate and 10% sodiumthiosulfate, 1 x 40 ml water, 1 x 40 ml brine and dried over magnesium sulfate. Filtration, solvent evaporation, and flash chromatography using 30% EtOAc/hexanes afforded the pure aldehyde (0.5 g, 67% 2 steps). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 500 Mhz) d 11.09 (s, 1H), 8.33 (dd, 1H, J = 8, 1 Hz), 8.20 (dd, 1H, J = 8, 1 Hz), 7.93 (t, 1H, J = 8 Hz), 7.54 (m, 2H), 7.45 (m, 3H).
  • Synthesis of Structure (71)
  • Figure 01950001
  • To 3 ml tetrahydrofuran in a 25 ml round-bottomed flask was added 0.066 ml (0.69 mmol) of methyl propiolate and the solution was cooled to -78°C. n-Butyl lithium (0.28 ml, 0.69 mmol) was added dropwise and the reaction allowed to stir for 7-10 min at which point a 3 ml dichloromethane solution of 0.15g (0.6mmol) of the aldehyde of structure (70) was rapidly added. The reaction was stirred at -78°C for 35-45 min then it was quenched with 1.5 ml of saturated ammonium chloride solution. The organic solvents were removed under reduced pressure and the aqueous layer was extracted with 24 ml of EtOAc which in turn was washed with brine. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and the solvent evaporated under reduced pressure to afford the crude product. Preparative TLC purification using 40% EtOAc/hexanes afforded product (107 mg, 47%). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 500 MHz) d 7.98 (dd, 1H, J = 7.0, 1.0 Hz), 7.88 (dd, 1H, J = 7.5, 1 Hz), 7.83 (d, 1H, J = 7.0 Hz), 7.54 (m, 2H), 7.45 (m, 3H), 6.01 (d, 1H, J = 9 Hz), 5.02 (d, 1H, J = 9 Hz), 3.78 (s, 3H). MS (EI) 335 (M+), 275.
  • Example 26 (Comparative Example) Activity of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • In this example, the compounds of Example 25 were assayed for inhibition of TNF induced V-CAM expression in human umbilical vein entothelial cells (HUVEC). Upon stimulation with inflammatory cytokines, HUVEC express cell surface adhesion molecules, including E-selectin, V-CAM, and I-CAM. Proteasome antagonists inhibit TNFα induced expression of these adhesion molecules, thereby providing a mechanism for regulating leucocyte adhesion and the inflammatory response.
  • More specifically, compounds (65), (68), (69) and (71) were assayed by the procedures set forth by Deisher, Kaushansky and Harlan ("Inhibitors of Topoisomerase II Prevent Cytokine-Induced Expression of Vascular Cell Adhesion Molecule-1, While Augmenting the Expression of Endothelial Leukocyte Adhesion Molecule-1 on Human Umbilical Vein Endothelial Cells," Cell Adhesion Commun. 1:133-42, 1993) (incorporated herein by reference), with the exception that tetramethyl benzidine was used in place of o-phenylenediamine-peroxide.
  • The results of this experiment are as follows: compound (65), 9.6±0.1µM; compound (68), 14.2±0.8µM; compound (69), 32.4±1.7µM; and compound (71) 4.9±0.18µM.
  • Example 27 Synthesis of Representative Linkers Used in the Solid Phase Synthesis of β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the synthesis of linkers used in the solid-phase synthesis of β-sheet mimetics.
    Figure 01980001
  • Synthesis of Structure (72):
  • Figure 01980002
  • In a 500 mL round-bottomed flask were placed tris(methylthio)methyl arginol (30) (10.70 g, 14.8 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (20 mL) with magnetic stirring. In a 125 mL Erlenmeyer flask were placed cysteine methyl ester hydrochloride (3.81 g, 22.2 mmol), CH2Cl2 (50 mL), and diisopropylethylamine (8.5 mL, 6.3 g, 48.7 mmol). This mixture was stirred until the cysteine methyl ester had dissolved (25 min), and the solution appeared as a faintly cloudy suspension of diisopropylethylamine hydrochloride. This suspension was added to the flask containing the arginol and additional CH2Cl2 (100 mL) was added to the reaction. HgCl2 (17.7 g, 65.1 mmol) and HgO (5.46 g, 25.2 mmol) were added to the reaction mixture and the suspension was stirred rapidly enough so that the mercury salts remained suspended. The flask was lightly capped and stirred at room temperature for 22 h, by which time the starting material had been consumed. The yellow solution was quenched with saturated ammonium chloride and diluted with CH2Cl2. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer extracted 2× with CH2Cl2. The combined organic layers were dried over Na2SO4/MgSO4 and filtered through a pad of silica gel. The solvents were removed in vacuo and the residue purified two successive times on silica gel, the first time eluting with 7:3 ethyl acetate/hexane, and the second time eluting with 1:1 ethyl acetate/hexane, then 7:3 ethyl acetate/hexane. The combined purifications afforded 7.97 g (75% yield) of the N α,NG -bisBoc-NG '-Mtr-1-[(4'-carboxymethyl)thiazolin-2-yl] arginol as a pale yellow foam.: 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.81 (s, 1H, NG-H), 8.30 (t, J = 5.5 Hz, 1H, Nd-H), 6.54 (s, 1H, ArH), 5.12 (t, J = 8.5 Hz, 1H, CHOH), 4.95 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H, BocNH), 4.45 (bs, 1H, NCHCO2Me), 3.83 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.80 (s, 3H, CO2CH3), 3.64 (dd, J = 11.5, 9.0 Hz, 1H, CH2S), 3.58 (t, J = 8.5 Hz, 1H, CH2S), 3.37-3.31 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 3.31-3.25 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 2.70 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.63 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.14 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.54-1.70 (m, 4H, CβH and Cγ H) , 1.49 (s, 9H, NG Boc), 1.40 (s, 9H, Nα Boc), CαH not observed.
  • Synthesis of Structure (73):
  • Figure 02000001
  • A 300 mL round-bottomed flask was charged with chloroform (20 mL) and arginol (72) (7.97 g, 11.1 mmol), and equipped for magnetic stirring. Manganese(IV)dioxide (9.65 g, 111 mmol, 10 eq.) was added, and the flask was stoppered. Additional chloroform (10 mL) was added, and the suspension was vigorously stirred for 8 h at room temperature after which time it was filtered through silica gel, rinsing with ethyl acetate. The solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue was purified by column chromatography on silica gel, (45:55 EtOAc/hexane) to give N α,N G-bisBoc-N G'-Mtr-1-[(4'-carboxymethyl)thiazol-2-yl] arginol (4.83 g, 61% yield) as a pale yellow amorphous solid, and 1.89 g (24%) of recovered starting material.: 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) d 9.84 (s, 1H, NG-H), 8.36 (bs, 1H, Nδ-H), 8.15 (s, 1H, SCH=C), 6.54 (s, 1H, ArH), 5.10 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1H, BocNαH), 3.95 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.95-3.87 (m, 1H, CaH), 3.83 (s, 3H, CO2CH3), 3.43-3.33 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 3.33-3.25 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 2.70 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.63 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.14 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.80-1.55 (m, 4H, CβH and Cγ H), 1.50 (s, 9H, NGBoc), 1.35 (s, 9H, NαBoc); IR (neat) 3328, 1727, 1619, 1566, 1278, 1242, 1152, 1121 cm-1; MS (ES+) m/z 714 (M+H+, 100) 736 (M+Na+, 9), 716 (35), 715 (45).
  • Synthesis of Structure (74):
  • Figure 02010001
  • To a 25 mL conical flask containing H2O (1 mL) was added 2.0N LiOH (0.25 mL, 0.50 mmol, 1.5 eq.) and N α,NG -bisBoc-NG '-Mtr-1- [(4'-carboxymethyl)thiazol-2-yl] arginol (238 mg, 0.33 mmol) as a solution in THF (1 mL). A second portion of THF (1 mL) was used to rinse the flask containing the arginol and added to the reaction. The homogeneous mixture was magnetically stirred at room temperature for 6.5 h at which time 5% HCl (0.34 mL, 0.55 mmol) and ethyl acetate (10 mL) were added. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer extracted with 2 × 10 mL ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were washed with saturated NaCl and dried over Na2SO4. The solvent was removed to afford 212 mg (92% yield) of Nα ,N G-bisBoc-N G'-Mtr-1-[(4'-carboxylic acid)thiazol-2-yl] arginol as a pale yellow foam.: 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.84 (s, 1H, NG-H), 8.39 (t, J = 5.0 Hz, 1H, Nδ-H), 8.22 (s, 1H, SCH=C), 6.54 (s, 1H, ArH), 5.11 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1H, BocNαH), 4.02-3.95 (m, 1H, CαH), 3.95 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.45-3.36 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 3.36-3.27 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 2.69 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.63 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.14 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.83-1.62 (m, 4H, CβH and Cγ H), 1.50 (s, 9H, NGBoc), 1.34 (s, 9H, NαBoc) ; MS (ES+) m/z 700.3 (M+H+, 100), 722.3 (M+Na+, 10), 702.3 (20), 701.3 (38).
  • Synthesis of Structure (75):
  • Figure 02020001
  • A 250 mL round-bottomed flask equipped for magnetic stirring was charged with CH2Cl2 (10 mL), the acid (74) (3.40 g, 4.86 mmol), and trifluoroacetic acid (2 mL). After 1.5 h the reaction was incomplete. Additional trifluoroacetic acid (5 mL) was added and the solution was stirred 4 h more. The solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue taken up in THF (50 mL). Saturated NaHCO3 solution (50 mL) was added (pH∼7-8) followed by 9-fluorenylmethyl-N-succinimidyl carbonate (1.97 g, 5.83 mmol, 1.2 eq.) in THF (20 mL). After 16 h stirring at room temperature, starting material was still present and the pH=7.0. A 2 M Na2CO3 solution (∼3 mL) was added (pH=8.5) followed by a second portion of FmocONSu (328 mg, 0.97 mmol, 0.2 eq.). The solution was stirred for 2 h more at room temperature. The reaction mixture was washed 2 × 100 mL hexane. Ethyl acetate (100 mL) was added and the reaction mixture acidified to pH=0 with 6 N HCl. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer extracted 2 × 100 mL ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were washed with saturated NaCl and dried over Na2SO4. The solvent was removed to afford the crude Fmoc acid as a brown foam. This foam was dissolved in a minimum of ethyl acetate and pipetted into ethyl ether (250 mL). The precipitate was centrifuged and collected. The supernatant was concentrated and dropped into ethyl ether (50 mL). The white precipitate was centrifuged and the combined precipitates dried in vacuo to afford 3.42 g (98% yield) of the N α-Fmoc-N G'-Mtr-1-[(4'-carboxylic acid) thiazol-2-yl] arginol as a white powder.: 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 8.07 (s, 1H, SCH=C), 7.70 (d, J = 7.0 Hz, 2H, Fmoc ArH), 7.46 (dd, J = 5.0, 7.5 Hz, 2H, Fmoc ArH), 7.34 (dd, J = 4.0, 7.5 Hz, 2H, Fmoc ArH), 7.23 (d, J = 7.5 Hz, 2H, Fmoc ArH), 6.49 (s, 1H, ArH), 4.94 (s, 1H, FmocNaH), 4.32-4.23 (m, 2H, FmocCH2), 4.07 (t, J = 5.5 Hz, 1H, FmocCH), 4.02-3.95 (m, 1H, CaH), 3.78 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.27-3.17 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 3.17-3.10 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 2.64 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.57 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.08 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.74-1.49 (m, 4H, CbH and Cg H) ; MS (ES+) m/z 722.3 (M+H+, 85), 736.3 (M+Na+, 21), 723.2 (35).
  • Synthesis of Structure (76) :
  • Figure 02030001
  • The arginol ester derivative (42) (1.35 g, 1.93 mmol) was dissolved in 70 mL of EtOAc at room temperature. To the solution was added manganese (IV) dioxide (5 g, 89.2 mmol) and the suspension was stirred vigorously for 5 h at room temperature after which time it was filtered through silica gel. The solvent was removed and the residue was purified by flash chromatography (30% hexane/EtOAc) to give the desired alcohol (76) (0.23 g, 18%) and the ketone (0.153 g, 11.5%). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 9.80 (s, 1H, NG-H), 8.34 (bs, 1H, Nδ-H), 7.65 (s, 1H, NCH=C), 6.54 (s, 1H, ArH), 5.20 (b, 1H, BocNαH), 4.89(s, 1H CHOH), 4.15 (b, 1H cαH), 3.84 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.83 (s, 3H, CO2CH3), 3.70-3.6 (b, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 3.25-3.15 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 2.70 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.63 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.14 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.80-1.55 (m, 4H, CβH and Cγ H), 1.50 (s, 9H, NGBoc), 1.35 (s, 9H, NαBoc); MS (ES+) m/e 697 (M+H+, 100).
  • Synthesis of Structure (77):
  • Figure 02040001
  • The ester (76) (70 mg, 0.1 mmol) was dissolved in a mixture of THF (10 mL) and water (10 mL). To the solution was added LiOH (18 mg, 4.3 mmol) and the solution was heated to reflux for 7 h. The resulting solution was evaporated. The residue was dissolved in water and extracted with ether. The aqueous layer was evaporated. The resulting residue was dissolved in MeOH, and Dowex resin (50W×8, H+ form) was added to acidify the solution. The resin was filtered off, and the filtrate was evaporated to furnish the acid (35 mg, 60%). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CD3OD) δ 7.7(s, 1H, NCH=C), 6.70 (s, 1H, ArH), 4.3 (m, 1H, CαH), 3.87 (s, 3H, ArOCH3), 3.34 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 3.3-3.2 (m, 1H, CH2-guanidine), 2.69 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.61 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 2.14 (s, 3H, ArCH3), 1.73-1.62 (m, 4H, CβH and CγH), 1.34 (s, 9H, NαBoc) ; MS (ES+) m/z 583.3 (M+H+, 100).
  • Synthesis of Structure (78):
  • Figure 02050001
  • To 4-(chloroethyl)benzoic acid (8.0 g, 0.046 mol) in CH3CN/DMF (80 mL:80 mL) were added NaN3 (6.0 g, 0.092 mol), tetra-n-butylammonium azide (cat.), tetra-n-butylammonium iodide (cat.) and the reaction was heated at gentle reflux for 7-9 h at which point the reaction mixture transformed into one solid block. Water (350 mL) and EtOAc (500 mL) were added and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc(2×400 mL). The organic layer was washed with H2O (250 mL), brine (300 mL) and dried over Na2SO4. Filtration and solvent evaporation afforded a yellowish solid (9.4 g) which was pure enough to use in the next step. IR (CDCl3) v-1 2111.
  • Synthesis of Structure (79):
  • Figure 02050002
  • To a solution of (78) (9.4 g, 0.053 mol) in THF/DME (175 mL:60 mL) was added triphenylphosphine (15.2 g, 0.058 mol) and the reaction was stirred for 10 m. H2O (1.2 mL) was added and the reaction was vigorously stirred at rt for 22-24 h at which point the solution turned into a thick suspension. The off-white solid was filtered and washed with THF (3×40 mL) to afford, after drying, 16.4 g of pure iminophosphorane. MS (ES+) (M+H+) 426.1.
  • Synthesis of Structure (80) :
  • Figure 02060001
  • The iminophosphorane (79) was suspended in THF/H2O (320 mL : 190 mL) and 2N HCl (64 mL) was added and the reaction was heated at reflux for 5 h. Concentrated HCl (11 mL) was added and reflux continued for an additional 20 h. The solvents were removed under vacuo and the resultant off-white solid was dried under high vacuum for 2 h (18.0 g) and used in the next step without further purification.
  • Synthesis of Structure (81):
  • Figure 02060002
  • To a suspension of 4-(aminoethyl)benzoic acid .HCl (80) (9.0 g, 0.019 mol, theoretical) in CH3CN (320 mL) was added TEA (7.7 mL, 0.053 mol) and the suspension was cooled to 0 °C. Fmoc-ONSu (9.3 g, 0.026 mol) was added in one portion and the reaction was allowed to warm to rt over 1 h and stirred an additional 1 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in EtOAc (1200 mL), washed with 10% citric acid (220 mL) and brine (220 mL) and dried over Na2SO4. Filtration and solvent evaporation afforded the crude product which was purified by flash chromatography using 8% MeOH/CHCl3 to afford pure product (2.4 g). 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 2.81 (t, 2H, J = 7.0 Hz), 3.36 (m, 2H), 4.15 (t, 1H, J = 6.5 Hz), 4.36 (d, 2H, J = 7.0 Hz), 5.24 (br s, 1H), 7.18 (d, 2H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.26 (m, 2H), 7.35 (t, 2H, J = 7.5 Hz), 7.52 (d, 2H, J = 7.5 Hz), 7.71(d, 2H, J = 7.5 Hz), 7.92 (d, 2H, J = 8.0 Hz). MS (ES+) (M+H+) 387.7.
    Figure 02070001
  • Synthesis of Structure (82):
  • Figure 02070002
  • To 2.20 g (8.4 mmol) of 4-iodo-methylbenzoate under nitrogen was added 1.95 g (12.26 mmol) of Boc-propargyl amine, 0.33 g (1.26 mmol) of triphenylphosphine, 0.08 g (0.42 mmol) of copper(I) iodide, 2.11 mL (15.1 mmol) of triethylamine, and 250 mL of DMF. The solution was stirred and degassed with nitrogen for 15 min followed by the addition of 0.10 g (0.42 mmol) of palladium(II) acetate and stirring at room temperature for 18 h. The solution was diluted with EtOAc and washed with 5% citric acid(4×), brine (2×) and dried over MgSO4. Purification by column chromatography (silica gel, 9:1 hexanes/EtOAc) afforded ester (82) (2.37 g, 98%) as an orange solid: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 500 MHz) δ 1.47 (s, 9H), 3.91 (s, 3H), 4.17 (m, 2H), 4.80 (broad s, 1H), 7.46 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 2H), 7.97 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 2H).
  • Synthesis of Structure (83):
  • Figure 02080001
  • To 2.86 g (9.88 mmol) of alkyne (82) under 1 atm of H2 was added 40 mL of anhydrous diethyl ether and a catalytic amount of platinum(IV) oxide. The reaction was monitored by TLC and complete after 13 h. The mixture was filtered through a pad of Celite, washed with diethyl ether and the solvent was removed in vacuo to give ester (83) (2.72 g 94%)as an orange oil: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 500 MHz) δ 1.44 (s, 9H), 1.82 (m, 2H), 2.69 (m, 2H), 3.15 (m, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.55 (broad s, 1H), 7.23 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.94 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 2H); MS (ES+) m/z 294 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (84) :
  • Figure 02080002
  • To 2.72 g (9.27 mmol) of ester (83) was added 1.17 g (27.18 mmol) of lithium hydroxide monohydrate, 50 mL of THE and 50 mL of H2O. The solution was stirred at room temperature for 16 h and quenched with 5% citric acid. The reaction was extracted with EtOAc (4×) and the combined extracts were washed with brine and dried over MgSO4. Removal of the solvent afforded acid (84) (2.38 g, 92%) as a pale yellow solid: 1H NMR (CD3OD, 500 MHz) δ 1.44 (s, 9H), 1.80 (m, 2H), 2.70(m, 2H), 3.07 (m, 2H), 7.30 (d, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.92 (d, J = 8.0 Hz).
  • Synthesis of Structure (85):
  • Figure 02090001
  • To 2.38 g of acid (84) was added 20 mL of dichloromethane and 20 mL of TFA. The solution was stirred for 2 h at room temperature and the solvent removed in vacuo to give amino acid (85) (3.57 g) as a pale orange solid: 'H NMR (CD3OD, 500 MHz) δ 1.98 (m, 2H), 2.79 (m, 2H), 2.95 (m, 2H), 7.35 (d, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.97 (d, J = 8.0 Hz).
  • Synthesis of Structure (86):
  • Figure 02090002
  • To 3.57 g (12.20 mmol)of amino acid (85) was added 70 mL of 1,4 dioxane, 70 of H2O, 1.29 g (12.20 mmol), and 4.93 g (14.6 mmol) of N-(9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyloxy)succinimide. The cloudy mixture was stirred for 48 h, diluted with a large volume of EtOAc and washed with saturated ammonium chloride. The mixture was extracted with EtOAc (3×) and the combined organics were washed with saturated bicarbonate, brine and dried over sodium sulfate. Removal of the solvent in vacuo gave a pale yellow solid which was washed with ether to afford acid (86) (2.85 g 58%; 83% based on (75) as a white powder: 1H NMR (CD3OD, 500 MHz) δ 1.81 (m, 2H), 2.68 (m, 2H), 3.12 (m, 2H), 4.37 (m, 2H),7.30 (m, 4H), 7.38 (m, 2H), 7.65 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 2H), 7.79 (d, J = 7.5 Hz, 2H), 7.92 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 2H); MS (ES+) m/z 402 (M+H+).
    Figure 02100001
  • Synthesis of Structure (87):
  • Figure 02110001
  • A solution of cyanomethyl triphenylphosphonium chloride (CMTPP) (8.2 g, 24 mmol) was prepared in 75 mL of dichloromethane and stirred for 10 m. With the addition of Fmoc-Lys(Boc) (10 g, 21.3 mmol), 1-(dimethylaminopropyl) -3-ethyl carbodiimide hydrochloride (EDCI) (4.9 g, 25.6 mmol) and 4-Dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP) (2.2mmol), the reaction vessel was sealed and stirred for twelve hours at room temperature. The solvent was concentrated in vacuo to an oil which was dissolved in 300 mL of ethyl acetate and 100 mL 1N HCl with stirring. The layers were separated and the organic phase was extracted 2×50 mL of brine. The ethyl acetate was dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to a solid. This material was used without further purification. MS (ES+) 752 (M+H+)
  • Synthesis of Structure (88):
  • Figure 02120001
  • The compound of structure (87) (16 g, 21.3 mmol) was dissolved in 100 mL of MeOH and cooled to -78°C. Ozone was bubbled through the reaction solution with a gas dispersion tube for 3 h. The product was isolated by removal of MeOH under reduced pressure and was purified on a silica gel column (200 g dry weight) equilibrated in a mobile phase of ethyl acetate/hexane (3:7). The product was eluted with ethyl acetate/hexane (4:6), and gave after drying 5.1 g (47% for the two steps). MS (ES+) 511 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (89):
  • Figure 02120002
  • The keto ester (88) (5.1g, 9.8 mmol) was dissolved in 100 mL of THF. After the addition of tetramethylammonium borohydride (1.4 g, 11.8 mmol) to the solution, the vessel was sealed and stirred for 4 h. The reaction was incomplete at this point and more borohydride (0.21 g, 2.4mmol) was added and stirring was continued for an additional h. The reaction mixture was concentrated to an oil in vacuo and applied to a silica gel column (150g dry weight) equilibrated and eluted with ethyl acetate/hexane (4:6) to give 2.7 g (53%) of product. MS (ES+) 513 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (90) :
  • Figure 02130001
  • The hydroxy ester (89) (2.7 g, 5.3 mmol) was dissolved in 100 mL of THF and cooled to 0° - 5°C. 0.2N LiOH (66.5 mL, 13.3 mmol) was added to the chilled solution and stirred for thirty minutes. The reaction was incomplete at that time and more 0.2N LiOH (10.4 mL, 2.1 mmol) was added. The reaction was stirred of another thirty minutes and then quenched with 300 mL of ethyl acetate/0.2N HCl (2:1). The aqueous phase was separated, washed with 100 mL of ethyl acetate and the combined organic extracts were dried over magnesium sulfate and filtered. The filtrate was evaporated in vacuo to an oil and dried to a solid (2.0 g, 78%) CDCl3 δ 1.2-1.8 (m,15H), 3.1 (m,2H), 4.1-4.5 (m,5H), 4.6 (m,1H), 5.4 (m,1H), 7.2 (m,2H), 7.4 (m,2H), 7.6 (m,2H), 7.8 (m,2H); MS (ES+) 501 (M+H+).
  • Synthesis of Structure (91):
  • Structure (91) was synthesized by standard procedures as shown in the following scheme.
    Figure 02140001
  • Example 28 Synthesis of Representative Components for the Solid Phase Synthesis of β-Sheet Mimetics Urazole Synthesis
  • The following syntheses are representative of the procedures used to prepare the urazole components used in the solid phase synthesis of β-sheet mimetics of this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (92) :
  • Figure 02150001
  • Structure (92) was synthesized by a minor modification of the method of Cookson and Gupte (Org. Syntheses, Vol. VI (1988), 936). 2-n-Butylaniline (12.0 mL, 76.6 mmol) in 160 mL of EtOAc was added via addition funnel to 324 mL of 20% phosgene in toluene at rt over 30 min. The solution was refluxed 30 min, and the solvent removed by distillation. The residual oil was dissolved in 75 mL of chloroform and was added via addition funnel over 15 min to a suspension of methyl hydrazinocarboxylate (6.90 g, 76.6 mmol) in toluene at rt. The mixture was refluxed for 1.5 h during which time all the solids dissolved. Upon cooling to rt, a precipitate formed and was collected by vacuum filtration. It was washed with toluene and dried in vacuo to give 18.17 g of off-white powder (89%). The product was used in the next step without further purification. TLC (CH2Cl2/MeOH, 95/5) R f 0.12; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 0.94 (t, 3 H, J = 7.4 Hz), 1.39 (m, 2 H), 1.56 (m, 2 H), 2.61 (m, 2 H), 3.74 (s, 3 H), 7.09-7.21 (m, 4 H); MS (ES+) m/z 265.8 (M+H-, 100).
  • Synthesis of Structure (93):
  • Figure 02160001
  • The compound of structure (92) (18.03 g, 68.0 mmol) was suspended in 190 mL of 4 N KOH and heated to reflux for 2 hours. Upon cooling, the now clear pink solution was extracted with ether (6×) and acidified with concentrated HCl. The precipitate was collected by vacuum filtration, washed with water and EtOAc, and dried in vacuo overnight to yield 14.00 g of white solid (88%). [If necessary, urazoles may be recrystallized from MeOH or another suitable solvent system.] TLC (CH2Cl2/MeOH/AcOH, 94/4/2) Rf 0.63; Purity* by UV: 397%; 1H NMR (CD3OD) δ 0.89 (t, 3 H, J = 7.3 Hz), 1.32 (m, 2 H), 1.51 (m, 2 H), 7.18-7.42 (m, 4 H); MS (ES-) m/z 232 (M-H+). Note: urazoles generally give poor mass spectra.
  • Synthesis of Structure (94) :
  • Figure 02170001
  • 4-(Fluoromethyl)-benzylamine (4.1 mL, 28.5 mmol) was added to a stirring solution of methyl hydrazinocarboxylate (2.56 g, 28.5 mmol) and 1,1'-carbonyldiimidazole (4.62 g, 28.5 mmol) in THF (25 mL). The solution was stirred at room temperature for 18 hours. A white precipitate formed that was collected by vacuum filtration, washed with cold THF, and dried in vacuo to yield 3.22 g of (94) (39%). 1H NMR (DMSO-d6 ) δ 3.57 (s, 3H), 4.26 (d, 2H, J = 6.0 Hz), 7.44 (d, 2H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.64 (d, 2H, J = 8.0 Hz); MS (ES+) m/z 292 (M+H+, 100).
  • Synthesis of Structure (95):
  • Figure 02170002
  • The compound of structure (94) (3.22 g, 11.0 mmol) was suspended in 20 mL of 4 N KOH and heated to reflux for 3 hours. Upon cooling the solution was acidified with concentrated HCl. A white precipitate formed and was collected by vacuum filtration, washed with cold water, and dried in vacuo overnight to yield 2.45 g of white solid (86%). Purity by UV: 3 83%; 1H NMR (DMSO) δ 4.62 (s, 2H), 7.46 (d, 2H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.70 (d, 2H, J = 8.0 Hz), 10. 29 (bs, 2H); MS (ES-) m/z 258 (M-H+ , 100).
  • Diene Synthesis
  • The following syntheses are representative of the procedures used to prepare the diene components used in the solid phase synthesis of β-sheet mimetics of this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (95):
  • Figure 02180001
  • A solution of methacrolein (7.01 g, 100 mmol) and methyl (triphenylphosphoranilidene)acetate (35.11 g, 105 mmol) in 150 mL of dry dichloromethane was refluxed for 2 h under a nitrogen atmosphere. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure, and the product was purified by chromatography on a short silica gel column (EtOAc-hexanes, 1:9). After evaporation of the product-containing fractions, compound (95) was obtained as a clear oil (8.71 g, 69%). TLC (EtOAc-hexanes, 1:4) R f 0.59 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 1.89 (s, 3 H), 3.76 (s, 3 H), 5.33-5.37 (m, 2 H), 5.87 (d, J = 16 Hz, 1 H), 7.37 (d, J = 16 Hz, 1H).
  • Synthesis of Structure (96):
  • Figure 02190001
  • Compound (96) was synthesized by a modification of the procedure of K. Sato et al. (J. Org. Chem. 32:177, 1967). To a suspension of NaH (60% in mineral oil, 0.40 g, 10 mmol) in 25 mL of dry THF, cooled to 0° under a nitrogen atmosphere, triethyl phosphonocrotonate (2.50 g, 10 mmol) was added dropwise with stirring. After the addition, the solution was stirred at 0 °C for 1.5 h. To the brown-red solution, maintained at 0 °C, 3,3-dimethylbutyraldehyde (1.00 g, 10 mmol) was added dropwise. The solution was allowed to warm up to room temperature, and stirred for 1 h at room temperature. The mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate (75 mL) and water (75 mL), and the two layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with water (2×50 mL) and brine (75 mL), and dried over sodium sulfate. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and flash chromatography on silica (EtOAc/hexanes, 1:9) yielded 1.00 g (51%) of (96) as a pale yellow solid. TLC (EtOAc/hexanes, 1:9) R f 0.60 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 0.90 (s, 9 H), 1.29 (t, J = 7 Hz, 3H), 2.04 (d, J = 6 Hz, 2 H), 4.19 (q, J = 7 Hz, 2H), 5.80 (d, J = 15.5 Hz, 1H), 6.13-6.17 (m, 2H), 7.24-7.39 (m, 2H).
  • Synthesis of Structure (97):
  • Figure 02200001
  • A solution of methyl 7,7-dimethyl-2,4-octadienoate (96) (0.99 g, 5 mmol) and sodium hydroxide (0.60 g, 15 mmol) in methanol (15 mL) and water (5 mL) was refluxed for 30 min. After cooling to room temperature, the solvent was removed in vacuo, and the residue was dissolved in water (30 mL). The resulting solution was acidified with conc. HCl to pH 2, and the precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with water (10 mL), and dried in vacuo to yield 0.84 (99%) of the acid as a white solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ 0.92 (s, 3 H), 2.07 (d, J = 6.5 Hz, 2 H), 5.80 (d, J = 15.5 Hz, 1H), 6.19-6.23 (m, 2H), 7.34-7.40 (m, 2H).
  • Example 29 Solid Phase Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example illustrates the solid phase synthesis of representative β-sheet mimetics (100) through (227) (Tables 11-15). Compounds Nos. 101, 119-121, 154, 163-167, 169, 172, 183, 184, 205, 226, 227-1 through 227-10 and 227-12 through 227-14 are according to this invention, while the remaining compounds are shown for purpose of comparison. The compounds of this example were synthesized according to the following reaction scheme:
    Figure 02210001
  • General Procedure: The synthesis of β-strand mimetics was initiated by deprotection of Fmoc PAL resin using 25% piperidine in DMF. Following extensive washing with DMF, the resin was treated with the acid fluoride of N-Fmoc-4-aminomethylbenzoic acid, or (81), or (86) and Hunigs' base in DMF until the Kaiser test was negative. Alternatively, the Fmoc-protected thiazole- (75) or imidazole-based (77) linkers were coupled to the resin using BOP, HOBt and DIEA. In some instances Fmoc-Leu or another amino acid was attached to the resin prior to the thiazole- (75) or imidazole-based (77) linkers via the same methodology. In the case of structures (217)-(221), the isocyanate (91) was coupled to Wang resin overnight in the presence of catalytic HCl in dichloromethane. Deprotection of all Fmoc-protected linkers was effected by treatment with 25% piperidine in DMF, and deprotection the Boc-protected linker (77) was effected by TMS-Cl (1 M) and phenol (3 M) in dichloromethane for 30 min. The lysinol derivative (90) was coupled to resin-bound linkers N-Fmoc-4-aminomethylbenzoic acid, (81), or (86) using PyBOP, HOBt and Hunigs' base in DMF until a negative Kaiser test was achieved. Treatment of the resin with 25% piperidine in DMF then cleaved the FMOC group. Following washing with DMF a dienoic acid was coupled to the resin-bound linkers using PyBOP, HOBt and Hunigs' base in DMF until the result of a Kaiser test was negative. The cycloaddition was performed by pretreatment of a solution of a pyrazolidinedione (not shown) or urazole in DMF with a solution of [bis(trifluoroacetoxy)iodo]benzene in DMF. The polymer-supported diene was treated with the resulting solution for 2-16 hours. The resin was then washed with DMF and CH2Cl2. Oxidation to the ketoamide was effected by treatment of the resin with a solution of Dess-Martin periodinane in DMSO for 60 min. The resin was washed with CH2Cl2 and the product was cleaved from the resin by treatment of the resin with 95:5 TFA:H2O for 1-12 h. The supernatant was collected and the resin was washed with additional TFA. The combined filtrates were concentrated in vacuo. The residue was precipitated with diethyl ether and the ether was decanted. The resulting solid was reconstituted in 1:1 CH3CN:H2O and lyophilized. Compounds (100) through (227) in Tables 11-15 each gave the expected (M+H+) peak when submitted to LCMS (ES+). The compounds were assayed for inhibition of coagulation enzymes as mixtures of diastereomers.
  • All of the compounds listed in Tables 11-15 had Ki < 100 nM as thrombin inhibitors, or had activity as Factor VIIa inhibitors (Table 15). The compounds noted with an "*" in Tables 11-15 had a Ki < 10 nM as thrombin inhibitors and represent preferred embodiments.
    Figure 02230001
    Figure 02240001
    Figure 02250001
    Figure 02260001
    Figure 02270001
    Figure 02280001
    Figure 02290001
    Figure 02300001
    Figure 02310001
    Figure 02320001
    Figure 02330001
    Figure 02340001
    Figure 02350001
    Figure 02360001
    Figure 02370001
    Figure 02380001
    Figure 02390001
    Figure 02400001
    Figure 02410001
    Figure 02420001
    Figure 02430001
    Figure 02440001
    Figure 02450001
    Figure 02460001
    Figure 02470001
    Figure 02480001
    Figure 02490001
  • Example 30 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example further illustrates the synthesis of representative β-sheet mimetics not according to this invention.
    Figure 02500001
  • Synthesis of Structure (228) :
  • Figure 02500002
  • Methyl-2,4-dioxo-pentanoate (14.4 g, 0.10 mol) and 10.6 g of trimethyl orthoacetate were dissolved in 100 mL of methanol followed by the addition of 300 µL of acetyl chloride. This solution was then stirred at room temperature for 6 h. An aliquot was then taken and the solvent removed using a rotary evaporator. 1H NMR analysis of the residue suggested a complete conversion to the methyl enol ether. The reaction solution was evaporated in vacuo. By 1H NMR, purity was 90%, and the material was used for the next step without purification.
  • 2-Methoxy-4-oxo-2-pentenone (1.58 g, 10 mmol) and 1.63 g of t-butyldimethylsilyl chloride (11 mmol) were dissolved in 15 mL of DMF. Triethylamine (1.553 mL, 12 mmol) was added and the reaction stirred overnight under argon at rt. The next morning 50 mL of hexane was added and the reaction was extracted with cold NaHCO3 solution. The hexane layer was dried over Na2SO4 and hexane removed under vacuum to give 2.01 g of the diene as an oil (78%), which was used without further purification. NMR (CDCl3) δ 0.16 (s, 6H), 0.94 (s, 9H), 3.53 (s, 3H),3.73 (s, 3H),4.32 (bs, 1H), 4.6 (bs,1H 6.21 (s,1H).
  • Synthesis of Structure(229):
  • Figure 02510001
  • To a mixture of 4-phenyl urazole (177 mg, 1 mmol) and iodobenzene diacetate(322 mg, 1 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) was added a solution of the diene (228) (269 mg, 1.05 mmol) in CH2Cl2. The reaction mixture was stirred 30 min, and then cooled to 0°C. BF3.OEt2 (141 mg, 1 mmol) was added dropwise and the reaction stirred for 30 min, diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 mL), washed with NaHCO3 solution (2×15 mL), water (15 mL) and brine, dried and evaporated. Crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica gel (EtOAc/hexane, 1:3, v/v) to afford pure product (97 mg,32%). 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.53-7.42 (m, 5H),6.30 (s, 1H), 4.47 (s, 2H), 3.97 (s, 3H); MS (EI, 12 eV) 301 (M+, 100), 273.4, 246.3, 154.4, 119.5.
  • Example 31 (Comparative Example) Synthesis of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics
  • This example further illustrates the synthesis of representative β-sheet mimetics not according to this invention.
  • Synthesis of Structure (24)
  • Figure 02520001
  • To a 250 mL flame-dried round bottom flask was added 130 mL of dry THF. The flask was cooled to -78°C under an argon atmosphere, and 10 mL of 2.5 M n-BuLi were added followed by 5.3 mL of hexamethyldisilazane. This solution was stirred at -78°C for 30 min., and then 2.2 mL of methyl propiolate were added. After stirring at -78°C for 50 min., 2.5 mL (22 mmol) of hexadienal were added. The reaction was then slowly warmed to -30°C over a period of 4 h. After an hour at -30°C, it was quenched by addition of aqueous tartaric acid solution. The reaction mixture was then partitioned between EtOAc and water, and the aqueous layer was washed with additional ethyl acetate. The combined organic layers were then washed with saturated sodium chloride, dried over sodium sulfate, and concentrated to give about 4.1 g of a reddish oil. Flash chromatography via silica gel (20% ethyl acetate/80% hexane) gave 3.1 g of a yellowish oil (78%). 1H NRM (CDCl3) δ 1.78 (d, 3H, J=9), 3.79, (s, 3H), 5.01 (bs, 1H), 5.63 (dd, 1H, J=9, 16), 5.84 (m, 1H), 6.06 (m, 1H), 6.38 (dd, 1H, J=16, 9).
  • Synthesis of Structure (25)
  • Figure 02530001
  • A 500 mL roundbottom flask was charged with phenyl urazole (4.91 g) and 150 mL of methylene chloride. Iodobenzene diacetate (8.94 g) was added to the flask and the reaction stirred for 10 min. as a deep red color developed. A solution of 5.0 g of compound (230) dissolved in 50 mL of methylene chloride was then added, and the reaction instantaneously decolorized. The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3 additional hours. The solvent was removed on rotary evaporator and the residue placed under high vacuum overnight. The residue was purified via flash chromatography on silica gel (40% EtOAc/hexane) to give 8.3 g of a ∼60/40 diastereomeric mixture of epimeric alcohols (84%). 1H NMR (CDCl3) (isomer 1): δ 1.474 (d, 3H, J=7), 3.773 (s, 3H), 4.66 (m, 2H), 4.83 (s, 1H), 5.73 (d, 1H, J=10), 6.19 (bd, 1H, J=10), 7.4=7.56 (m, 5H); (isomer 2): δ 1.53 (d, 3H, J=7), 3.77 (s, 3H), 4.64 (m, 1H, 4.72 (m, 1H), 5.18 (bs, 1H), 6.1 (s, 2H) 7.36-7.56 (m, 5H); MS (ES+) : 356 (M+1), 378 (M+Na).
  • Synthesis of Structure (26)
  • Figure 02540001
  • A solution of 1.0 g of (231) as a diastereomeric mixture of acetylene alcohols was dissolved in 40 mL of MeOH and cooled to 0°C in an ice bath. To the reaction mixture 80 mg (∼3 equivalents of hydride) of powdered sodium borohydride was added with stirring. After an hour at 0°C, the reaction was warmed to room temperature and stirred for an additional hour. It was quenched by addition of 100 mL EtOAc and 60 mL of water. The layers were separated in a separatory funnel, and the aqueous phase extracted twice with additional EtOAc. The combined organic phases were then washed with saturated sodium chloride and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic solvent was removed by rotary evaporator and the residue purified by flash chromatography (40/60 EtOAc/hexanes) to give 630 mg of a mixture of diastereomeric alcohols (∼63%). 1H NMR (CDCl3) isomer 1: δ 1.39 (d, 3H, J=11), 3.78 (s, 3H), 4.68 (m, 1H), 4.71 (m, 1H), 4.75 (m, 1H), 5.81 (d, 1H, J=10), 6.16 (dm, 1H, J=10), 6.26 (d, 1H, J=9), 7.01 (d, J=9), 7.01 (d, J=9), 7.35=7.5 (m, 5H). Isomer 2: 1.43 (d, 3H, j=10), 3.72 (s, 3H), 4.5 (m, 2H), 5.53 (d, 1H, J=12), 5.86 (m, 2H), 6.12 (d, 1H, J=10), 6.89 (d, 1H, J=10), 7.35-7.5 (m, 5H). MS (ES+) 358 (M+1).
  • Synthesis of Structure (27)
  • Figure 02550001
  • To a solution of 357 mg of compound (231) as a diastereomeric mixture in 50 mL of methylene chloride was added 424 mg of powdered Dess-Martin reagent. The reaction stirred at room temperature for 6 h. It was then stirred for five minutes with a sodium thiosulfate solution and extracted with aqueous bicarbonate solution. The organic phase was washed with saturated sodium chloride and dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate. The methylene chloride was removed by rotary evaporation to give 348 mg of a solid residue (97%). δ 1.61 (d, 3H, J=9Hz), 3.82 (s, 3H), 4.52 (bm, 1H), 5.16 (s, 1H), 5.93 (bd, 1H, J=10Hz), 6.01 (bd, 1H, J=10Hz), 6.88 (d, 1H, J=15Hz), 7.29 (d, 1H, J=15Hz), 7.35-7.55 (m, 5H); MS (EI) 355 (M°).
  • Synthesis of Structure (28)
  • Figure 02550002
  • A 100 mL roundbottom flask was charged with 357 mg of compound (232) as an isomeric mixture of alcohols and 25 mL of THF. The reaction solution was cooled to 0°C, the reaction was allowed to warm up to room temperature, and stirred for an additional hour. It was then extracted with 40 mL of EtOAc and 30 mL of water. The aqueous phase was acidified with 1 mmol of tartaric acid, and reextracted with 40 mL of fresh EtOAc. The organic phase was dried over anhydrous NaSO4, filtered and the solvent removed via rotary evaporator to give 328 mg of a solid residue. 1H NMR (CDCl3) isomer 1: δ 1.37 (d, 3H, J=6.5), 4.61 (m, 1H), 4.65 (m, 1H), 4.68 (m, 1H), 5.77 (d, 1H, J=11), 6.12 (d, 1H, J=11), 6.23 (d, 1H, J=15), 7.083 (d, 1H, J=15), 7.35-7.54 (m, 5H); isomer 2: 1.47 (d, 3H, J=6.5), 4.5 (m, 1H), 4.58 (m, 1H), 4.96 (m, 1H), 5.9 (m, 2H), 6.12 (d, 1H, J=16), 6.98 (d, 1H, J=16) 7.35=7.54 (m, 5H).
  • Example 32 (Comparative Example)
  • In this example, compounds (231) and (233) of Example 31 were assayed for their ability to block insulin disulfide reduction by thioredoxin. Thioredoxin has been shown to up-regulate NF-kB for DNA binding by reduction of a disulfide bond involving Cys62 of the p50 subunit of NF-kB. Thioredoxin is also known to reduce the disulfide bonds in insulin 104 times faster than low molecular weight thiols (Holmgren, J. Biol. Chem. 254:9627-9632, 1979) (incorporated herein by reference). Therefore, if an inhibitor of NF-kB activation is acting via inhibition of thioredoxin, it should also be able to block reduction of insulin by thioredoxin. The following assay measures spectrophotometrically the increasing turbidity of insulin at 650 nm as its disulfide bonds are reduced in the presence of thioredoxin.
  • A slight modification of the method of Holmgren was used. On a 96 well microtiter plate solutions of thioredoxin in 0.1 M potassium phosphate pH 6.5 buffer were preactivated for 15 minutes in the presence of 0.33 mM dithiothreitol (DTT) and 2 mM EDTA. Solutions of substrate and inhibitor were added to a final concentration of 8 µM thioredoxin, 0.13 mM insulin, and 0-100 µM of either compound (231) or (233). The turbidity of the solutions was measured at 650 nM over the course of 60 minutes on a Spectra Max 250 absorbance plate reader (Molecular Devices). The results demonstrate that turbidity decreases with increasing concentration of compounds (231) or (233).
  • As a negative control, inhibitor in the presence of DTT and EDTA, but without thioredoxin present did not display turbidity (DTT did not reduce thioredoxin over the time period examined). As a positive control, the structurally related natural products parthenolide and santonin were tested in the above assay in place of the inhibitors. Parthenolide, which contains an unsaturated exomethylene lactone and is known to inhibit NF-kB activation in a concentration dependent fashion (Bork et al., FEBS Lett. 402: 85-90, 1997), similarly blocked thioredoxin-induced turbidity of insulin. Santonin, which contains a saturated lactone group and does not inhibit NF-kB activation, did not block thioredoxin-induced turbidity of insulin. Taken together, these results are evidence that compounds (231) and (233) prevent NF-kB activation by inhibition of thioredoxin.
  • Example 33 (Comparative Example) Activity of a Representative β-Sheet Mimetic as a Protease Inhibitor
  • Figure 02580001
  • This example further illustrates the activity of a β-sheet mimetic of structure (234) (prepared by methods disclosed in reaction scheme 20) as an inhibitor of the metalloproteinases leucine aminopeptidase M and thermolysin. The method is a modification of that of Spungin-Bialik et al., FEBS Lett. (1996) 380, 79-82.
  • The following protocol was used: A buffer solution containing 50 mM Tris-Cl, 100 mM NaCl, 1 mM CaCl2, 0.005% Triton X-100 (pH=7.5) is prepared. A second buffer solution, 40 mM in EDTA, is prepared from the first. A 750 µM solution of substrate, Suc-Ala-Ala-Phe-pNA, is prepared in water from a 50 mM stock solution DMSO. A 15 nM solution of thermolysin is prepared by diluting with buffer a 200 µM thermolysin stock solution in 20% glycerol/H2O. Dilute the commercially available solution of Leucine Aminopeptidase M (Sigma, 2.6mg/ml stock in H2O) down to 50 µg/ml with buffer. The inhibitor in 50% EtOH/H2O was diluted with water to 3× the desired concentration levels. Add 50µl of enzyme, substrate, and inhibitor per well (96 well microtiter plate) to the desired number of microtiter strips. This will yield final concentrations of 5 nM for thermolysin and 250 µM for the substrate. The wells should then be incubated at rt for 20 minutes. After 20 minutes, add the EDTA in buffer solution to all wells at 50µl per well. and add simultaneously to the wells at 50µl per well. This will yield a final concentration of 10µg/ml. The plate should be read 100× at 405 nm with 21 second intervals. Ki values were calculated as before (Example 5). The values of Ki obtained for compound (234) were 6 and 11 µM for thermolysin and leucine aminopeptidase M, respectively. These results demonstrate that the β-sheet mimetic can function as a metalloproteinase inhibitor.
  • Example 34 (Comparative Example) Activity of a Representative β-Sheet Mimetic as a Protease Inhibitor
  • Figure 02590001
  • This example further illustrates the activity of a β-sheet mimetic of structure (235) (prepared by methods disclosed in reaction scheme 15) as an inhibitor of the cysteine proteinase, papain. The assay method is a modification of that of Mellor et al., Biochem. J. (1993) 290, 289.
  • The assay was conducted in a microtiter plate as in Example 4. The following protocol was used: Prepare a buffer containing 0.05 M sodium citrate, 0.15 M NaCl, 2 mM DTT, 1 mM EDTA (pH=6.5). A 2 mM stock solution of substrate (Ac-Phe-Gly-pNA) is diluted to 200 µM in buffer. A 5 mM stock solution (in 50% EtOH/H2O) of the inhibitor is diluted to 500 µM in buffer, and six serial 1:5 dilutions are made. Aliquots of 100 µL each of buffer, substrate, and inhibitor (at the appropriate concentrations) are added per well to an eight well microtiter strip. A 1.0 mM stock solution of papain is diluted to 200 µM in buffer and incubated for 5 min prior to addition of a 100 µL aliquot to the assay wells. The plate should be read 100× at 405 nm with 21 second intervals. IC50 values were calculated as before (Example 4). Compound (234) exhibited an IC50 value of 8 µM. This result demonstrates that a β-sheet mimetic of this invention can function as a cysteine proteinase inhibitor.
  • Example 35 Activity of Representative β-Sheet Mimetics as Antithrombotic Agents
  • This example illustrates the activity of β-sheet mimetics of structures (221-14) and (221-21) of Table 14 as antithrombotic agents. Rats (Splague Dawley) were fasted overnight and used under pentobarbital anesthesia. A polyethylene tube containing a 5 cm silk thread was placed between the right cartid artery and the left junglar vein. Thirty minutes after oral administration of 100 mg.kg of one of the above compounds (dissolved with 50% propylene glycol at 20 mg/ml, and orally administered 5 ml/kg), or one minute after intravenous administration of the Argatroban (0.3 mg/kg), blood was circulated through the tube for seven minutes. At the end of circulation, the tube was removed and the thrombus wet weight and thrombus protein content were measured. Blood was also withdrawn from the abdominal artery and APTT was measured.
  • The results of these experiments are presented in Figures 5A and 5B, which plot thrombus protein (µg/thrombus) for each of a negative control (without added compound), compound 221-14 (Figure 5A) or 221-21 (Figure 5B) and Argatroban (a positive control). These results illustrate that both of the tested compounds significantly inhibit thrombus formation.

Claims (15)

  1. A compound having the structure:
    Figure 02620001
    and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof,
       wherein
    A is selected from -C(=O)-, -(CH2)0-4-, -C(=O) (CH2)1-3-, -(CH2)1-2O- and -(CH2)1-2S-;
    B is selected from N and CH;
    C is selected from -C(=O) (CH2)1-3-,-(CH2)0-3-, -O-(CH2)1-2- and -S(CH2)1-2-;
    D is selected from N and C(R4);
    E is selected from
    Figure 02620002
    and
    Figure 02620003
    R1, R3 and R4 are independently selected from amino acid side chain moieties and derivatives thereof;
    R2 and R2' represent one or more ring substituents individually selected from an amino acid side chain moiety and derivatives thereof, wherein at least one R2 taken together with C forms a fused substituted or unsubstituted homocyclic or heterocyclic ring;
    R' is a ring substituent;
    Y and Z represent the remainder of the molecule; and
    any two adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring may form a double bond.
  2. The compound of claim 1 wherein E is
    Figure 02630001
  3. The compound of claim 1 wherein E is
    Figure 02630002
  4. The compound of claim 1 wherein E is
    Figure 02630003
    with the proviso that Z does not contain an -NH- moiety attached to the carbon atom bearing the R1 substituent.
  5. The compound of claim 1 having the structure:
    Figure 02630004
  6. The compound of claim 1 having the structure:
    Figure 02640001
       wherein X is selected from -C(=O)-, -NH-, -NR'-, -O-and -S-.
  7. A compound having the structure:
    Figure 02640002
    and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof,
       wherein
    A is selected from -C(=O)-, -(CH2)0-4-, -C(=O) (CH2)1-3-, -(CH2)1-2O- and -(CH2)1-2S-;
    B is selected from N and CH;
    C is selected from -C(=O)-, -C(=O)(CH2)1-3-,-(CH2)0-3-, -O-, -S-, -O-(CH2)1-2- and -S(CH2)1-2-;
    D is selected from N and C(R4) ;
    E is selected from
    Figure 02650001
    and
    Figure 02650002
    R1, R3 and R4 are independently selected from amino acid side chain moieties and derivatives thereof;
    R2 and R2' represent one or more ring substituents individually selected from an amino acid side chain moiety and derivatives thereof, wherein at least one R2 taken together with y forms a fused substituted or unsubstituted homocyclic or heterocyclic ring;
    Y and Z represent the remainder of the molecule; and
    any two adjacent CH groups of the bicyclic ring may form a double bond.
  8. The compound of claim 7 wherein E is
    Figure 02650003
  9. The compound of claim 7 wherein E is
    Figure 02650004
  10. The compound of claim 7 wherein E is
    Figure 02650005
    with the proviso that Z does not contain an -NH- moiety attached to the carbon atom bearing the R1 substituent.
  11. The compound of claim 7 having the structure:
    Figure 02660001
  12. The compound of claim 7 having the structure:
    Figure 02660002
       wherein X is selected from -NH-, -NR'-, -O- and -S-, and the ring bearing X is a five-, six-, seven- or eight-membered ring.
  13. A compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 12 for use in therapy.
  14. Use of a compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 12 for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of cardio vascular disease, inflammatory disease or oncology or cancer.
  15. A composition comprising a compound according to any of Claims 1 to 12 and pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
EP98908551A 1998-02-12 1998-02-12 Beta-sheet mimetics and methods relating to the use thereof Expired - Lifetime EP1053246B1 (en)

Applications Claiming Priority (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
PCT/US1998/002891 WO1999041276A1 (en) 1998-02-12 1998-02-12 β-SHEET MIMETICS AND METHODS RELATING TO THE USE THEREOF

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
EP1053246A1 EP1053246A1 (en) 2000-11-22
EP1053246B1 true EP1053246B1 (en) 2003-01-02

Family

ID=22266392

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP98908551A Expired - Lifetime EP1053246B1 (en) 1998-02-12 1998-02-12 Beta-sheet mimetics and methods relating to the use thereof

Country Status (9)

Country Link
EP (1) EP1053246B1 (en)
JP (1) JP2002503674A (en)
KR (1) KR20010040939A (en)
AT (1) ATE230414T1 (en)
AU (1) AU748887B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2319766A1 (en)
DE (1) DE69810513T2 (en)
ES (1) ES2192764T3 (en)
WO (1) WO1999041276A1 (en)

Families Citing this family (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6699855B2 (en) * 2000-02-29 2004-03-02 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Inhibitors of hepatitis C virus NS3 protease
US6534651B2 (en) 2000-04-06 2003-03-18 Inotek Pharmaceuticals Corp. 7-Substituted isoindolinone inhibitors of inflammation and reperfusion injury and methods of use thereof
US7122679B2 (en) 2000-05-09 2006-10-17 Cephalon, Inc. Multicyclic compounds and the use thereof
US20060276497A1 (en) 2000-05-09 2006-12-07 Cephalon, Inc. Novel multicyclic compounds and the use thereof
WO2003068237A1 (en) * 2002-02-14 2003-08-21 Myriad Genetics, Inc. Beta-sheet mimetics and composition and methods relating thereto
WO2009158369A1 (en) 2008-06-25 2009-12-30 Schering Corporation Synthesis and use of heterocyclic antibacterial agents
CN111349053A (en) 2014-10-06 2020-06-30 库特克希米公司 Inhibitors of lysine porphyromonas gingivalis protease
CN108602787A (en) 2015-11-09 2018-09-28 库特克希米公司 The inhibitor of arginine porphyromonas mycoproteinase
TWI756257B (en) 2016-08-31 2022-03-01 大陸商江蘇恆瑞醫藥股份有限公司 Oxo-pyridine amide derivatives, preparation process thereof and pharmaceutical use thereof
EP3512846B1 (en) 2016-09-16 2024-08-14 Lighthouse Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Ketone inhibitors of lysine gingipain
JP2021529201A (en) 2018-07-02 2021-10-28 江▲蘇▼恒瑞医▲薬▼股▲フン▼有限公司Jiangsu Hengrui Medicine Co., Ltd. Crystal form of oxypyridinamide derivative and its preparation method
CN114206854B (en) 2019-09-27 2023-02-24 深圳信立泰药业股份有限公司 FXIa inhibitor and preparation method and medical application thereof

Family Cites Families (9)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
AU668707B2 (en) * 1992-02-14 1996-05-16 Merrell Pharmaceuticals Inc. Aminoacetylmercaptoacetylamide derivatives useful as inhibitors of enkephalinase and ACE
CA2133963C (en) * 1992-05-15 1998-07-07 Gary A. Flynn Novel mercaptoacetylamido pyridazo[1,2]pyridazine, pyrazolo[1,2]pyridazine, pyridazo[1,2-a][1,2]diazepine and pyrazolo[1,2-a][1,2]diazepine derivatives useful as inhibitors of enkephalinase and ace
EP0618223A3 (en) * 1993-03-08 1996-06-12 Sandoz Ltd Peptides inhibiting interleukin 1-bêta release useful as antiinflammatory agents.
HUT77651A (en) * 1994-12-22 1998-07-28 Biochem Pharma Inc. Oxazolo- and thiazolo[3,2-a]pyridine-, pyrrolo[1,2-a]pyrazine- and pyrido [2,1-c][1,4]-thiazinecarboxamidoarginine derivatives, process for their preparation and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
WO1996030396A1 (en) * 1995-03-24 1996-10-03 Molecumetics Ltd. β-SHEET MIMETICS AND USE THEREOF AS PROTEASE INHIBITORS
AU713530B2 (en) * 1995-03-24 1999-12-02 Molecumetics, Ltd. Beta-sheet mimetics and use thereof as protease inhibitors
US5877313A (en) * 1995-05-17 1999-03-02 Bristol-Myers Squibb Benzo-fused azepinone and piperidinone compounds useful in the inhibition of ACE and NEP
IT1277405B1 (en) * 1995-08-01 1997-11-10 Menarini Farma Ind BICYCLIC LACTAM DERIVATIVES AS THROMBIN INHIBITORS
AU732174B2 (en) * 1996-08-05 2001-04-12 Myriad Genetics, Inc. Use of beta-sheet mimetics as protease and kinase inhibitors and as inhibitors of transcription factors

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
ATE230414T1 (en) 2003-01-15
CA2319766A1 (en) 1999-08-19
AU748887B2 (en) 2002-06-13
ES2192764T3 (en) 2003-10-16
DE69810513D1 (en) 2003-02-06
WO1999041276A1 (en) 1999-08-19
AU6655798A (en) 1999-08-30
DE69810513T2 (en) 2004-03-18
JP2002503674A (en) 2002-02-05
EP1053246A1 (en) 2000-11-22
KR20010040939A (en) 2001-05-15

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP0915700B1 (en) Use of beta-sheet mimetics as protease and kinase inhibitors and as inhibitors of transcription factors
AU712581B2 (en) Beta-sheet mimetics and use thereof as inhibitors of biologically active peptides or proteins
US6372744B1 (en) β-sheet mimetics and methods relating to the use thereof
US6245764B1 (en) β-sheet mimetics and use thereof as inhibitors of biologically active peptides or proteins
WO1996030396A1 (en) β-SHEET MIMETICS AND USE THEREOF AS PROTEASE INHIBITORS
EP1053246B1 (en) Beta-sheet mimetics and methods relating to the use thereof
US6020331A (en) β-sheet mimetics and use thereof as protease inhibitors
US7511039B2 (en) β-sheet mimetics and use thereof as inhibitors of biologically active peptides or proteins
US20030191109A1 (en) Beta-sheet mimetics and use thereof as inhibitors of biologically active peptides or proteins
AU733205B2 (en) Beta-sheet mimetics and use thereof as inhibitors of biologically active peptides or proteins
EP1661566A2 (en) Use of beta-sheet mimetics as protease and kinase inhibitors and as inhibitors of transcription factors
AU5421301A (en) Use of beta-sheet mimetics as protease and kinase inhibitors and as inhibitors of transcription factors

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
PUAI Public reference made under article 153(3) epc to a published international application that has entered the european phase

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009012

17P Request for examination filed

Effective date: 20000822

AK Designated contracting states

Kind code of ref document: A1

Designated state(s): AT BE CH DE DK ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LI LU MC NL PT SE

GRAG Despatch of communication of intention to grant

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: EPIDOS AGRA

17Q First examination report despatched

Effective date: 20011105

17Q First examination report despatched

Effective date: 20011212

GRAG Despatch of communication of intention to grant

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: EPIDOS AGRA

GRAH Despatch of communication of intention to grant a patent

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: EPIDOS IGRA

GRAH Despatch of communication of intention to grant a patent

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: EPIDOS IGRA

GRAH Despatch of communication of intention to grant a patent

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: EPIDOS IGRA

GRAA (expected) grant

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009210

STAA Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent

Free format text: STATUS: THE PATENT HAS BEEN GRANTED

AK Designated contracting states

Kind code of ref document: B1

Designated state(s): AT BE CH DE DK ES FI FR GB GR IE IT LI LU MC NL PT SE

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: NL

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

Ref country code: LI

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

Ref country code: GR

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

Ref country code: FI

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

Ref country code: CH

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

Ref country code: BE

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

Ref country code: AT

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030102

REF Corresponds to:

Ref document number: 230414

Country of ref document: AT

Date of ref document: 20030115

Kind code of ref document: T

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: GB

Ref legal event code: FG4D

Free format text: 20030102

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: CH

Ref legal event code: EP

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: IE

Ref legal event code: FG4D

REF Corresponds to:

Ref document number: 69810513

Country of ref document: DE

Date of ref document: 20030206

Kind code of ref document: P

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: LU

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20030212

Ref country code: IE

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20030212

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: MC

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20030228

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: SE

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030402

Ref country code: PT

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030402

Ref country code: DK

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20030402

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: CH

Ref legal event code: PL

ET Fr: translation filed
REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: ES

Ref legal event code: FG2A

Ref document number: 2192764

Country of ref document: ES

Kind code of ref document: T3

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: FR

Ref legal event code: RN

PLBE No opposition filed within time limit

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009261

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: FR

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20031127

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: IE

Ref legal event code: MM4A

26N No opposition filed

Effective date: 20031003

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: FR

Ref legal event code: ST

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: FR

Ref legal event code: FC

PGFP Annual fee paid to national office [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: ES

Payment date: 20100129

Year of fee payment: 13

PGFP Annual fee paid to national office [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: IT

Payment date: 20100130

Year of fee payment: 13

Ref country code: FR

Payment date: 20100222

Year of fee payment: 13

PGFP Annual fee paid to national office [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: GB

Payment date: 20100125

Year of fee payment: 13

Ref country code: DE

Payment date: 20100226

Year of fee payment: 13

GBPC Gb: european patent ceased through non-payment of renewal fee

Effective date: 20110212

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: FR

Ref legal event code: ST

Effective date: 20111102

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: IT

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20110212

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: DE

Ref legal event code: R119

Ref document number: 69810513

Country of ref document: DE

Effective date: 20110901

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: GB

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20110212

REG Reference to a national code

Ref country code: ES

Ref legal event code: FD2A

Effective date: 20120411

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: ES

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20110213

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: DE

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF FAILURE TO SUBMIT A TRANSLATION OF THE DESCRIPTION OR TO PAY THE FEE WITHIN THE PRESCRIBED TIME-LIMIT

Effective date: 20110901

PG25 Lapsed in a contracting state [announced via postgrant information from national office to epo]

Ref country code: FR

Free format text: LAPSE BECAUSE OF NON-PAYMENT OF DUE FEES

Effective date: 20110228